blob: a3e36353dc3f303541038e1112aa9ec390e168e5 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau1a38ffc2020-11-21 16:00:40 +01007 2020/11/21
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200121
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012210. FastCGI applications
12310.1. Setup
12410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12510.1.2. Proxy section
12610.1.3. Example
12710.2. Default parameters
12810.3. Limitations
129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130
1311. Quick reminder about HTTP
132----------------------------
133
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
136on almost anything found in the contents.
137
138However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
139formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
140correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
141
142
1431.1. The HTTP transaction model
144-------------------------------
145
146The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100147to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100148from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
149connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150will involve a new connection :
151
152 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
153
154In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
155establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
156by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
157length.
158
159Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
160to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
161however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
162response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
163header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
168power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
169but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
174second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
175page :
176
177 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
178
179This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
180latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
181correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
182the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100183server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100185The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
186time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
187are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
188parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
189carry the stream identifier.
190
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
192connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
193leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
195processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
196waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200197
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200198HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100199 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
200 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100201 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206
2071.2. HTTP request
208-----------------
209
210First, let's consider this HTTP request :
211
212 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
215 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
216 3 User-agent: my small browser
217 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
218 5 Accept: image/png
219
220
2211.2.1. The Request line
222-----------------------
223
224Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
225
226 - a METHOD : GET
227 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
228 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
229
230All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
231which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
232followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
233is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
234desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
235the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
236
237The URI itself can have several forms :
238
239 - A "relative URI" :
240
241 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
244 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
245
246 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
247
248 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
251 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
252 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
253 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
254 must accept this form too.
255
256 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
257 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
258 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200260 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
261 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
262 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
263 other protocols too.
264
265In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
266mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
267on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
268It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
269specific to the language, framework or application in use.
270
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100271HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100272assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200274
2751.2.2. The request headers
276--------------------------
277
278The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
279beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
280an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
281Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
282values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
283encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
284the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
285define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100287Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100289"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200290as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
291normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
292representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
293HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
295The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
296that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
297is one valid form of empty line.
298
299Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
300headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
301about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
302application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
303
304Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000305 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
307 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
308 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
309
310
3111.3. HTTP response
312------------------
313
314An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
315messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
316
317 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100318 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
320 2 Content-length: 350
321 3 Content-Type: text/html
322
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200323As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
324codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
325response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100326continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
327the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
328following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
329sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
330(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
331correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
332such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
333state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
334over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
335if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
336information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200338
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003391.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340------------------------
341
342Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
343
344 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
345 - a status code : 200
346 - a reason : OK
347
348The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100349 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
350 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
351 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
352 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
353 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000355Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100356"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200357found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
358messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
359or "Authentication Required".
360
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362
363 Code When / reason
364 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
365 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
367 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100368 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370 400 for an invalid or too large request
371 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
372 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200373 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100374 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100376 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
377 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
379 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
380 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200381 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
383 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
384 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
385
386The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3874.2).
388
389
3901.3.2. The response headers
391---------------------------
392
393Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
394the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
395details.
396
397
3982. Configuring HAProxy
399----------------------
400
4012.1. Configuration file format
402------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200403
404HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
405
406 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100407 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
408 - the running process' environment, in case some environment variables are
409 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100411The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
412a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
415
416 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
417
418 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
419 tab characters
420
421 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
422 keyword sequences listed in this document
423
424 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
425 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
426 parts of the configuration, or expressions
427
428 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
429 are supported
430
431 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
432 section
433
434This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
435generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
436figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
437
438First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
439the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
440a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
441word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
442follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
443the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
444the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
445the parts that need to be addressed.
446
447A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
448requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
449extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
450the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
451section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
452section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
453not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
454
455A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
456each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
457a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
458start a new one.
459
460Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
461that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
462applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
463"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
464processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
465ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
466which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
467In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
468of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
469identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
470such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4712, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
472
473 listen foo
474 bind :80
475
476 listen bar
477 bind :81
478
479Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
480spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
481of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
482following configurations are strictly equivalent:
483
484 global#this is the global section
485 daemon#daemonize
486 frontend foo
487 mode http # or tcp
488
489and:
490
491 global
492 daemon
493
494 # this is the public web frontend
495 frontend foo
496 mode http
497
498The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
499new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
500other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
501section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
502section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
503at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
504
505Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
506are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
507editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
508support automatic indent.
509
510In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
511positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
512modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
513anymore, and is not recommended.
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005162.2. Quoting and escaping
517-------------------------
518
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100519In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
520that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
521possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
522in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
523('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200524
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100525This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
526very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
527the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
528also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
529delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
530word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
531remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
534(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
535
536Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
537backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200538
539 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
540 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
541 \\ to use a backslash
542 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
543 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
544
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100545In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
546C-language representation:
547
548 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
549 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
550 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
551 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
552
553Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
554or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
555of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200556
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100557 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200558 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
559 # hash as a comment start
560
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100561Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
562evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
563dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
564backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200565
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
567character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
568is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
571entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
572name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
573represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
574hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200575
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100576 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
577 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
578 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
579 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
580 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
581 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
582 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
583 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
584 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
585 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
586 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200587
588 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100589 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
591 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
592 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
593 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
594 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
595
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
597necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
598by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
599they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
600escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
601characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
602case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
603if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
604own quotes.
605
606The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
607quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
608not always obvious is that the delimitors used inside must first be escaped or
609quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
610
611Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
612arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
613
614 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
615 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
616
617Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
618"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
619cannot write:
620
621 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
622
623because we would like the string to cut like this:
624
625 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
626 |---------|----|-|
627 arg1 _/ / /
628 arg2 __________/ /
629 arg3 ______________/
630
631but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
632parenthesis then garbage:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |--------|--------|
636 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
637 trailing garbage _________/
638
639The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
640quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
641processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
642this word:
643
644 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
645 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
646 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
647
648So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
649still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
650the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
651the second level:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
656 |---------||----|-|
657 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
658 arg2=blah ___________/ /
659 arg3=g _______________/
660
661Another approch consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
662double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
663
664 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
665 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
666 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
667 |---------||----|-|
668 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
669 arg2 ___________/ /
670 arg3 _______________/
671
672When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
673appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
674string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
675thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
676
677 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
678 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
679 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
680 |-------------| |-----||-|
681 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
682 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
683 arg3 ______________________/
684
685Remember that backslahes are not escape characters withing single quotes and
686that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
687quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
688single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
689level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
690
691When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
692double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
693and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
694a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
695a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
696the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
697regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
698around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
699more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200700
701
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007022.3. Environment variables
703--------------------------
704
705HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
706interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
707configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
708optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
709shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200710underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
711list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
712arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
713before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200714
715 Example:
716
717 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
718
719 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
720
721 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
722
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200723Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
724file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200725
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200726* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
727 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
728
729* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
730 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
731 directory.
732
733* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
734
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500735* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200736 processes, separated by semicolons.
737
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500738* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200739 CLI, separated by semicolons.
740
741See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200742
7432.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200744----------------
745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100746Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100747values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
748otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
749numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
750for every keyword. Supported units are :
751
752 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
753 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
754 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
755 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
756 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
757 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
758
759
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00007602.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200761-------------
762
763 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
764 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
765 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
766 global
767 daemon
768 maxconn 256
769
770 defaults
771 mode http
772 timeout connect 5000ms
773 timeout client 50000ms
774 timeout server 50000ms
775
776 frontend http-in
777 bind *:80
778 default_backend servers
779
780 backend servers
781 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
782
783
784 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
785 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
786 global
787 daemon
788 maxconn 256
789
790 defaults
791 mode http
792 timeout connect 5000ms
793 timeout client 50000ms
794 timeout server 50000ms
795
796 listen http-in
797 bind *:80
798 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
799
800
801Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
802
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100803 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200804
805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008063. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200807--------------------
808
809Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
810are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
811of them have command-line equivalents.
812
813The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
814
815 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200816 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200818 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200819 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200821 - description
822 - deviceatlas-json-file
823 - deviceatlas-log-level
824 - deviceatlas-separator
825 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900826 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200827 - gid
828 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100829 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200830 - h1-case-adjust
831 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100832 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100833 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100834 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200835 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200836 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200837 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100838 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200839 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100840 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200841 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200842 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200843 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200844 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200845 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200846 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100847 - presetenv
848 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200849 - uid
850 - ulimit-n
851 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200852 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100853 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200854 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200855 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200856 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200857 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200858 - ssl-default-bind-options
859 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200860 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200861 - ssl-default-server-options
862 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100863 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200864 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100865 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100866 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100867 - 51degrees-data-file
868 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200869 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200870 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200871 - wurfl-data-file
872 - wurfl-information-list
873 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200874 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100875 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100876
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200877 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100878 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200879 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200880 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200881 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100882 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100883 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100884 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200885 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200886 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200887 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200888 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200889 - noepoll
890 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000891 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200892 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100893 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300894 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000895 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100896 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200897 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200898 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200899 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000900 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000901 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200902 - tune.buffers.limit
903 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200904 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200905 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100906 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200907 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200908 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200909 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200910 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100911 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200912 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200913 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200914 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100915 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100916 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100917 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100918 - tune.lua.session-timeout
919 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200920 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100921 - tune.maxaccept
922 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200923 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200924 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200925 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200926 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
927 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100928 - tune.rcvbuf.client
929 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100930 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200931 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200932 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100933 - tune.sndbuf.client
934 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100935 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200936 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100937 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200938 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100939 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200940 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200941 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100942 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200943 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100944 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200945 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
946 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
947 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100948 - tune.zlib.memlevel
949 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100950
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200951 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200953 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200954
955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009563.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200957------------------------------------
958
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200959ca-base <dir>
960 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100961 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
962 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
963 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200964
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965chroot <jail dir>
966 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
967 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
968 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
969 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
970 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100972
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100973cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
974 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
975 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
976 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
977 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
978 set. These sets have the format
979
980 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
981
982 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100983 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100984 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
985 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100986 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
987 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100988 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100989 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100990 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100991 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100992 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
993 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
994 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
995 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100996
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100997 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
998 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
999 on the machine's word size.
1000
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001001 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001002 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1003 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1004 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1005 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1006 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1007 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001008
1009 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001010 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1011
1012 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1013 # first 4 CPUs
1014
1015 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1016 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1017 # word size.
1018
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001019 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001020 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001021 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1022 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1023 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1024
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001025 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1026 # and so on.
1027 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1028 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1029 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1030
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001031 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001032 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1033 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1034 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1035
1036 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1037 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1038 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1039
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001040 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1041 # and a thread range.
1042 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1043 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1044 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1045
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001046crt-base <dir>
1047 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001048 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1049 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001050
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001051daemon
1052 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1053 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001054 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1055 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001057deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1058 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001059 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001060
1061deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001062 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001063 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1064
1065deviceatlas-separator <char>
1066 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1067 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1068
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001069deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001070 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1071 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1072 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001073
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001074external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001075 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1076 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001077 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1078 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1079 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1080 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1081 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001082
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001083gid <number>
1084 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
1085 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1086 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001087 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1088 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001089 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001090
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001091group <group name>
1092 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1093 See also "gid" and "user".
1094
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001095hard-stop-after <time>
1096 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1097
1098 Arguments :
1099 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1100 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1101 SIGUSR1 signal.
1102
1103 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1104 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1105 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1106
1107 Example:
1108 global
1109 hard-stop-after 30s
1110
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001111h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1112 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1113 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1114 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1115 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001116 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001117 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1118 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1119 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1120 specified in a proxy.
1121
1122 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1123 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1124 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1125 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1126 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1127 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1128 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1129
1130 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1131 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1132 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1133 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1134 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1135
1136 Example:
1137 global
1138 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1139
1140 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1141 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1142
1143h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1144 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1145 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1146 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1147 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1148 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1149 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1150 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1151 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1152
1153 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1154 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1155 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1156
1157 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1158 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1159
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001160insecure-fork-wanted
1161 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1162 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1163 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1164 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1165 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1166 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1167 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1168 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1169 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1170 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1171 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1172 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1173 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1174 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1175 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1176 disable it.
1177
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001178insecure-setuid-wanted
1179 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1180 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1181 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1182 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1183 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1184 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1185 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1186 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1187 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1188 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1189 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1190 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1191 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1192 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1193
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001194issuers-chain-path <dir>
1195 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1196 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1197 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1198 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1199 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1200 "issuers-chain-path".
1201 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1202 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1203 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1204 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1205 will share the chain in memory.
1206
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001207localpeer <name>
1208 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1209 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1210 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1211 the configuration parsing.
1212
1213 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1214 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1215
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001216log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
1217 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001218 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001219 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001220 configured with "log global".
1221
1222 <address> can be one of:
1223
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001224 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001225 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1226 port).
1227
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001228 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1229 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1230 port).
1231
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001232 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001233 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1234 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001235 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001236
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001237 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1238 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1239 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1240 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1241 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1242 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1243 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1244 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1245 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1246 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1247 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1248 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1249 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1250 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001251 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1252 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001253
1254 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1255 "fd@2", see above.
1256
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001257 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1258 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1259 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1260 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1261 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1262
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001263 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1264 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001265
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001266 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1267 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1268 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1269 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1270 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1271 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1272 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1273 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1274 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1275 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001276 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1277 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001278
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001279 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1280 one of the following :
1281
1282 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1283 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1284
1285 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1286 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1287
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001288 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1289 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1290 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1291 designed to be used with a local log server.
1292
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001293 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1294 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1295 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1296 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1297 logger consumes.
1298
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001299 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1300 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1301 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1302 used with a local log server.
1303
1304 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1305 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1306 designed to be used with a local log server.
1307
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001308 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1309 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1310 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1311 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1312
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001313 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1314 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1315 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1316 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1317 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1318
1319 <sample_size>
1320 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1321 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1322 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1323 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1324 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1325
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001326 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001327
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001328 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1329 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1330 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1331
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001332 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1333 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1334 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1335 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001336
1337 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001338 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1339 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1340 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1341 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1342 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1343 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001344
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001345 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001346
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001347log-send-hostname [<string>]
1348 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1349 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1350 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1351 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1352 the logs.
1353
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001354log-tag <string>
1355 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1356 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1357 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001358 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001359
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001360lua-load <file>
1361 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1362 used multiple times.
1363
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001364lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1365 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1366 variable.
1367 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1368 to "path".
1369
1370 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1371 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1372 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1373 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1374 will be checked earlier.
1375
1376 As an example by specifying the following path:
1377
1378 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1379 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1380
1381 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1382 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1383 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1384 paths if that does not exist either.
1385
1386 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1387 documentation.
1388
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001389master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001390 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1391 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1392 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001393 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001394 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1395 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001396 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1397 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1398 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1399 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1400 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001401
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001402 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001403
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001404mworker-max-reloads <number>
1405 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001406 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001407 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1408 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1409 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1410
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001411nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001412 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1413 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1414 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001415 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1416 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001417 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1418 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1419 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001420
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001421nbthread <number>
1422 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001423 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1424 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1425 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1426 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1427 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001428 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1429 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1430 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1431 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1432 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1433 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1434 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001435
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001436pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001437 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1438 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1439 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1440 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001441
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001442pp2-never-send-local
1443 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1444 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1445 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1446 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1447 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1448 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1449 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1450 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1451 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1452 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1453 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1454
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001455presetenv <name> <value>
1456 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1457 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1458 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1459 and "unsetenv".
1460
1461resetenv [<name> ...]
1462 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1463 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1464 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1465 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1466 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1467 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1468 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1469 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1470
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001471stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001472 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1473 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1474 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1475 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1476 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1477 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001478 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001479 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1480 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1481 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1482 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001483
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001484server-state-base <directory>
1485 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001486 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1487 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001488
1489server-state-file <file>
1490 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1491 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1492 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1493 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1494 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1495 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1496 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1497 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001498 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1499 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001500
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001501setenv <name> <value>
1502 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1503 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1504 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1505 and "unsetenv".
1506
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001507set-dumpable
1508 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001509 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1510 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1511 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1512 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1513 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1514 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1515 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1516 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1517 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1518 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1519 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1520 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1521 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1522 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1523 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1524 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1525 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001526
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001527ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1528 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1529 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001530 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001531 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001532 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1533 information and recommendations see e.g.
1534 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1535 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1536 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1537 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001538
1539ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1540 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1541 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1542 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1543 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1544 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001545 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1546 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1547 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001548 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001549
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001550ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1551 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1552 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1553 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1554 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1555 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1556
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001557ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1558 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1559 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1560 keyword to see available options.
1561
1562 Example:
1563 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001564 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001565
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001566ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1567 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1568 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001569 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001570 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001571 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1572 information and recommendations see e.g.
1573 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1574 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1575 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1576 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1577 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001578
1579ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1580 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1581 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1582 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1583 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1584 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001585 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1586 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1587 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1588 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001589
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001590ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1591 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1592 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1593 keyword to see available options.
1594
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001595ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1596 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1597 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1598 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001599 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001600 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001601 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1602 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1603 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1604 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001605 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1606 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1607 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1608
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001609ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1610 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1611 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001612 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001613 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001614 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1615
1616 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001617
1618 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1619 and won't try to remove them.
1620
1621 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1622
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001623ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001624 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001625 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1626 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001627
1628 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1629 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1630 optimize the startup time.
1631
1632 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1633 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1634 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1635
1636 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001637 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001638
1639 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001640 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1641
1642 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1643 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1644 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1645 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1646 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1647 bind configuration..
1648
1649 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1650 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1651 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1652 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1653 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1654 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1655 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1656 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1657
1658 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1659
1660 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1661 a cert bundle.
1662
1663 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1664 separately in several "crt".
1665
1666 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1667 since files are loading separately.
1668
1669 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1670 required to commit them.
1671
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001672 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001673 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001674
1675 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1676
1677 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1678
1679 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1680 not provided in the PEM file.
1681
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001682 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1683 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1684
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001685 The default behavior is "all".
1686
1687 Example:
1688 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1689 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1690 ssl-load-extra-files none
1691
1692 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1693
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001694ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1695 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1696 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1697 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1698
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001699ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001700 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001701 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1702 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1703 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1704 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1705 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1706 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001707 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001708
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001709stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1710 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1711 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1712 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001713 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001714 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001715
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001716 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1717 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1718 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001719
1720stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1721 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1722 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001723 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001724
1725stats maxconn <connections>
1726 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1727 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1728
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001729uid <number>
1730 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1731 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1732 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1733 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1734
1735ulimit-n <number>
1736 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1737 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1738 option.
1739
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001740unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1741 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1742
1743 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1744 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1745 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1746 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1747 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1748 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1749 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1750 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1751 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1752 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1753
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001754unsetenv [<name> ...]
1755 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1756 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1757 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1758 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1759 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1760 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1761 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1762
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001763user <user name>
1764 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1765 See also "uid" and "group".
1766
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001767node <name>
1768 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1769
1770 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1771 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1772 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1773 traffic.
1774
1775description <text>
1776 Add a text that describes the instance.
1777
1778 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1779 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1780 "<" and ">" characters.
1781
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100178251degrees-data-file <file path>
1783 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001784 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001785
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001786 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001787 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1788
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000178951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001790 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1791 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1792 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1793
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001794 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001795 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1796
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200179751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001798 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1799 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1800
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001801 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1802 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1803
180451degrees-cache-size <number>
1805 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1806 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1807 By default, this cache is disabled.
1808
1809 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001810 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1811
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001812wurfl-data-file <file path>
1813 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1814 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1815
1816 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1817 with USE_WURFL=1.
1818
1819wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1820 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1821 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1822 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1823
1824 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1825
1826 Valid WURFL properties are:
1827 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1828
1829 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1830 device.
1831
1832 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1833 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1834
1835 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1836 particular web request.
1837
1838 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1839 used Libwurfl API version.
1840
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001841 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1842 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1843
1844 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1845 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1846
1847 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1848
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001849 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1850 with USE_WURFL=1.
1851
1852wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1853 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1854 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1855
1856 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1857 with USE_WURFL=1.
1858
1859wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1860 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1861 thus before the chroot.
1862
1863 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1864 with USE_WURFL=1.
1865
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001866wurfl-cache-size <size>
1867 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1868 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001869 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001870 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001871
1872 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1873 with USE_WURFL=1.
1874
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001875strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001876 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1877 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1878 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1879 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1880 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001881
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018823.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001883-----------------------
1884
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001885busy-polling
1886 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1887 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1888 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1889 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1890 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1891 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1892 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1893 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1894 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1895 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1896 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1897 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1898 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1899 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1900 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1901 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1902 "poll" pollers.
1903
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001904 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1905 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1906 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1907
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001908max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1909 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1910 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1911 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1912 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1913 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1914 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1915 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1916 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1917
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001918maxconn <number>
1919 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1920 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1921 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001922 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1923 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1924 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1925 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001926 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1927 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1928 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1929 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1930 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1931 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001932
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001933maxconnrate <number>
1934 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1935 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1936 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1937 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1938 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1939 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1940 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1941 fairness.
1942
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001943maxcomprate <number>
1944 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001945 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001946 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1947 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1948 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001949 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001950 default value.
1951
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001952maxcompcpuusage <number>
1953 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1954 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1955 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1956 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1957 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1958 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1959 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1960 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1961
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001962maxpipes <number>
1963 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1964 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1965 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1966 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1967 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1968 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1969
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001970maxsessrate <number>
1971 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1972 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1973 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1974 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1975 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1976 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1977 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1978 fairness.
1979
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001980maxsslconn <number>
1981 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1982 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1983 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1984 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1985 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1986 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1987 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001988 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1989 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1990 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1991 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1992 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1993 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1994 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001995
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001996maxsslrate <number>
1997 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1998 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1999 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2000 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2001 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2002 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2003 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2004 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2005 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2006 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2007
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002008maxzlibmem <number>
2009 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2010 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2011 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002012 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2013 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2014 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2015
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002016noepoll
2017 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2018 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002019 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002020
2021nokqueue
2022 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2023 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2024 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2025
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002026noevports
2027 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2028 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2029 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2030 also "nopoll".
2031
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002032nopoll
2033 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2034 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002035 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002036 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2037 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002038
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002039nosplice
2040 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002041 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002042 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002043 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002044 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2045 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2046 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2047 "option splice-response".
2048
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002049nogetaddrinfo
2050 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2051 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2052
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002053noreuseport
2054 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2055 command line argument "-dR".
2056
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002057profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2058 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2059 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2060 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2061 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002062 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002063 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2064 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2065 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2066 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2067
2068 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2069 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2070 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2071 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2072 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002073 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2074 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2075 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2076 CLI.
2077
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002078spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002079 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2080 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2081 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2082 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2083 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2084 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002085
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002086ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002087 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002088 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002089 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2090 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2091 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2092 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2093 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002094 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2095 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002096 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2097 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2098 openssl configuration file uses:
2099 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2100
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002101ssl-mode-async
2102 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002103 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002104 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2105 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2106 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002107 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002108 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002109
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002110tune.buffers.limit <number>
2111 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2112 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2113 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2114 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2115 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002116 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002117 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2118 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2119 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2120 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2121 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2122 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2123 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2124 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2125 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2126
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002127tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2128 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2129 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2130 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2131 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2132
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002133tune.bufsize <number>
2134 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2135 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2136 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2137 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2138 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2139 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2140 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002141 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2142 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2143 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002144 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002145 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2146 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2147 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002148
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002149tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2150 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002151
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002152tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2153 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2154 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2155 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2156 this value. The default value is 1.
2157
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002158tune.fail-alloc
2159 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2160 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2161 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2162 gracefully.
2163
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002164tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2165 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2166 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2167 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2168 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2169 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2170
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002171tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2172 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2173 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2174 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2175 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2176 change it.
2177
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002178tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2179 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002180 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2181 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002182 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2183 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2184 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2185 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2186 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2187
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002188tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2189 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2190 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2191 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2192 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2193 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2194 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2195 recommended not to change this value.
2196
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002197tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2198 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2199 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2200 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2201 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2202 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2203 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2204 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2205
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002206tune.http.cookielen <number>
2207 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2208 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2209 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2210 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2211 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2212 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2213 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2214 to change this value.
2215
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002216tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002217 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2218 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002219 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002220 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002221 configuration directives too.
2222 The default value is 1024.
2223
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002224tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2225 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2226 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2227 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2228 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2229 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2230 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002231 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2232 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2233 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002234
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002235tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2236 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2237 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2238 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2239 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2240 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2241 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
2242 this option to "off". The default is on.
2243
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002244tune.idletimer <timeout>
2245 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2246 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2247 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2248 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2249 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2250 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002251 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002252 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002253 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2254
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002255tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2256 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2257 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2258 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2259 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2260 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2261 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2262 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2263 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2264 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2265
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002266tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2267 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002268 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002269 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2270 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002271 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002272 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2273 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2274
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002275tune.lua.maxmem
2276 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2277 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2278 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2279 memory.
2280
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002281tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2282 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002283 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2284 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002285 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002286
2287tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2288 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2289 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2290 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2291 check servers.
2292
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002293tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2294 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2295 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2296 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002297 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002298
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002299tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002300 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2301 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2302 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2303 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2304 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2305 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2306 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2307 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2308 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2309 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002310
2311tune.maxpollevents <number>
2312 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2313 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2314 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2315 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2316 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2317
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002318tune.maxrewrite <number>
2319 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2320 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2321 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2322 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2323 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2324 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2325 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2326 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2327 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2328 bufsize.
2329
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002330tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2331 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2332 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2333 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2334 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2335 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2336 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2337 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2338 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2339 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002340 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2341 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002342 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2343 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2344 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2345 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2346 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2347 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2348 setting this parameter to 0.
2349
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002350tune.pipesize <number>
2351 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2352 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2353 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2354 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2355 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2356 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2357
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002358tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2359 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2360 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2361 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2362 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2363 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2364 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002365 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002366
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002367tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2368 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2369 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2370 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2371 default is 20.
2372
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002373tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2374tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2375 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2376 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2377 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002378 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002379 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002380 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2381 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2382
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002383tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002384 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002385 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2386 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2387 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2388 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2389
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002390tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002391 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002392 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002393 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2394 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2395 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2396
2397tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2398 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2399 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2400 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2401 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2402 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2403 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2404 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2405 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2406 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002407
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002408tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2409tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2410 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2411 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2412 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002413 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002414 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002415 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2416 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2417 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2418 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2419 notifying haproxy again.
2420
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002421tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002422 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2423 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2424 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002425 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002426 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002427 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002428 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2429 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2430 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002431 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2432 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002433
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002434tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002435 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002436 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2437 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2438 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2439 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2440 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2441
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002442tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2443 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2444 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2445 performances. This is disabled by default.
2446
2447 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2448 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2449
2450 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2451
2452 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2453
2454 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2455
2456 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2457 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2458 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2459
2460 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2461 converted.
2462
2463 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2464 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2465 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2466 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2467 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2468 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2469 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002470 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2471 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002472
2473 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2474
2475 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2476 only need this line:
2477
2478 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2479
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002480tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2481 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002482 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002483 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2484 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2485 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2486 being used for too long.
2487
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002488tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2489 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2490 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2491 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2492 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2493 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2494 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2495 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2496 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2497 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2498 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002499 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002500 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002501
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002502tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2503 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2504 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2505 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2506 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002507 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002508 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2509 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002510 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2511 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002512
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002513tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2514 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2515 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2516 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2517 1000 entries.
2518
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002519tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2520 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2521 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2522 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2523
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002524tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002525tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002526tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2527tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2528tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002529 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2530 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2531 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2532 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2533 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2534 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2535 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2536 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002537
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002538 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2539 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2540 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2541 all available space is consumed.
2542 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2543 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2544 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002545
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002546tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2547 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002548 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002549 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002550 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002551 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2552
2553tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2554 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2555 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002556 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2557 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025593.3. Debugging
2560--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002561
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002562quiet
2563 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2564 line argument "-q".
2565
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002566zero-warning
2567 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2568 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2569 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2570 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2571 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2572 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2573
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010025753.4. Userlists
2576--------------
2577It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2578http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2579it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2580
2581userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002582 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002583 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2584
2585group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002586 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002587 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2588 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2589
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002590user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2591 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002592 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2593 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002594 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2595 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2596 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2597 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002598
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002599 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2600 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2601 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2602 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2603 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2604 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2605 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2606 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2607 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002608
2609 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002610 userlist L1
2611 group G1 users tiger,scott
2612 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002613
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002614 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2615 user scott insecure-password elgato
2616 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002617
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002618 userlist L2
2619 group G1
2620 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002621
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002622 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2623 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2624 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002625
2626 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002627
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002628
26293.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002630----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002631It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2632several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2633instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2634values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2635automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2636In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2637using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2638tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2639reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2640Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2641that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2642each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002643
2644peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002645 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002646 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2647
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002648bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2649 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2650 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2651
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002652disabled
2653 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2654 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2655 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2656
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002657default-bind [param*]
2658 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2659
2660default-server [param*]
2661 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2662
2663 Arguments:
2664 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2665 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2666 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2667 details.
2668
2669
2670 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2671
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002672enable
2673 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2674
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002675log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2676 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2677 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2678 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2679 more details.
2680
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002681peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002682 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2683 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002684 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2685 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2686 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2687 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2688 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002689
2690 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2691 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2692
2693 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002694 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2695 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2696 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002697
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002698 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2699 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002700
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002701 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2702 "server" keyword explanation below).
2703
2704server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002705 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002706 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2707 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2708 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2709 of this "peers" section).
2710 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2711
2712
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002713 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002714 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002715 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002716 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2717 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2718 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002719
2720 backend mybackend
2721 mode tcp
2722 balance roundrobin
2723 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2724 stick on src
2725
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002726 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2727 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002728
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002729 Example:
2730 peers mypeers
2731 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2732 default-server ssl verify none
2733 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2734 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002735
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002736
2737table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2738 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2739
2740 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2741 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002742 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002743 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2744 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2745 "stick-table" keyword).
2746
2747 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2748 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2749 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2750 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2751 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2752 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2753 of the stick-table name as follows:
2754
2755 peers mypeers
2756 peer A ...
2757 peer B ...
2758 table t1 ...
2759
2760 frontend fe1
2761 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2762
2763 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2764 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2765
2766 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2767 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2768 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2769 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2770 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2771 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2772 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2773
2774 peers mypeers
2775 peer A ...
2776 peer B ...
2777 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2778
2779 backend t1
2780 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2781
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002782 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002783 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2784 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2785
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090027863.6. Mailers
2787------------
2788It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2789If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2790in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2791
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002792mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002793 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2794 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2795
2796mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2797 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2798
2799 Example:
2800 mailers mymailers
2801 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2802 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2803
2804 backend mybackend
2805 mode tcp
2806 balance roundrobin
2807
2808 email-alert mailers mymailers
2809 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2810 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2811
2812 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2813 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2814
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002815timeout mail <time>
2816 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2817 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2818 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2819 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2820
2821 Example:
2822 mailers mymailers
2823 timeout mail 20s
2824 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002825
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020028263.7. Programs
2827-------------
2828In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2829master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2830managed the same way as the workers.
2831
2832During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2833sequence as a worker:
2834
2835 - the master is re-executed
2836 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2837 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2838 instance of the program
2839
2840During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2841
2842program <name>
2843 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2844 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2845 the management guide).
2846
2847command <command> [arguments*]
2848 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2849 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2850 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2851 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2852
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002853user <user name>
2854 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2855 See also "group".
2856
2857group <group name>
2858 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2859 See also "user".
2860
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002861option start-on-reload
2862no option start-on-reload
2863 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2864 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2865 program section.
2866
2867
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010028683.8. HTTP-errors
2869----------------
2870
2871It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2872imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2873several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2874
2875http-errors <name>
2876 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2877 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2878
2879errorfile <code> <file>
2880 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2881
2882 Arguments :
2883 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002884 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2885 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002886
2887 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2888 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2889 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2890 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2891 before any chroot is performed.
2892
2893 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2894
2895 Example:
2896 http-errors website-1
2897 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2898 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2899 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2900
2901 http-errors website-2
2902 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2903 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2904 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2905
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020029063.9. Rings
2907----------
2908
2909It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2910servers or traces.
2911
2912ring <ringname>
2913 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2914
2915description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002916 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002917 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2918
2919format <format>
2920 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2921
2922 Arguments:
2923 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2924 one of the following :
2925
2926 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2927 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2928 designed to be used with a local log server.
2929
2930 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2931 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2932 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2933 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2934 is the default.
2935
2936 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2937 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2938
2939 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2940 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2941
2942 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2943 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2944 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2945 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2946 logger consumes.
2947
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002948 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2949 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2950 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2951 with a local log server.
2952
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002953 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2954 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2955 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2956 used with a local log server.
2957
2958maxlen <length>
2959 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2960 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2961 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2962
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002963server <name> <address> [param*]
2964 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2965 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2966 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2967 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2968 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2969 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2970 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2971 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2972 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002973 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2974 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002975
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002976size <size>
2977 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2978 set to BUFSIZE.
2979
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002980timeout connect <timeout>
2981 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2982
2983 Arguments :
2984 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2985 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2986 as explained at the top of this document.
2987
2988timeout server <timeout>
2989 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2990
2991 Arguments :
2992 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2993 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2994 as explained at the top of this document.
2995
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002996 Example:
2997 global
2998 log ring@myring local7
2999
3000 ring myring
3001 description "My local buffer"
3002 format rfc3164
3003 maxlen 1200
3004 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003005 timeout connect 5s
3006 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003007 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003008
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020030093.10. Log forwarding
3010-------------------
3011
3012It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3013haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3014
3015log-forward <name>
3016 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3017
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003018backlog <conns>
3019 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3020 on connections accept.
3021
3022bind <addr> [param*]
3023 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003024 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3025 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3026 syslog protocol over TCP.
3027 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003028 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3029
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003030dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003031 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3032 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3033 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3034 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003035 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003036
3037log global
3038log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
3039 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3040 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3041 documentation.
3042 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3043 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3044 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3045 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3046 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3047
3048 Example:
3049 global
3050 log stderr format iso local7
3051
3052 ring myring
3053 description "My local buffer"
3054 format rfc5424
3055 maxlen 1200
3056 size 32764
3057 timeout connect 5s
3058 timeout server 10s
3059 # syslog tcp server
3060 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3061
3062 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003063 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3064 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003065 # all messages on stderr
3066 log global
3067 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3068 log ring@myring local0
3069 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3070 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3071 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3072 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3073 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003074
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003075maxconn <conns>
3076 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3077 10 is the default.
3078
3079timeout client <timeout>
3080 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3081
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020030824. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003083----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003084
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003085Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02003086 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003087 - frontend <name>
3088 - backend <name>
3089 - listen <name>
3090
3091A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
3092its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
3093section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003094section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003095
3096A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3097connections.
3098
3099A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3100to forward incoming connections.
3101
3102A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3103parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3104
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003105All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3106'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3107case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3108
3109Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3110logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3111proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3112However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3113name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3114
3115Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3116and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003117bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003118protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3119modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3120arbitrary criteria.
3121
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003122In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3123a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003124the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003125
3126 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3127 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3128 between responses and new requests.
3129
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003130 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3131 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3132 client-facing connection remains open.
3133
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003134 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3135 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003136
3137The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3138frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3139following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003140weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003141
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003142 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003143
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003144 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3145 ----+-----+-----+----
3146 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3147 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003148 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3149 ----+-----+-----+----
3150 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003151
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003152
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003153
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031544.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3155--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003156
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003157The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3158limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3159they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3160limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003161marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003162option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003163and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3164with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3165specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003166
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003167
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003168 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3169------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3170acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003171backlog X X X -
3172balance X - X X
3173bind - X X -
3174bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003175capture cookie - X X -
3176capture request header - X X -
3177capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003178clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3179clitcpka-idle X X X -
3180clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003181compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003182cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003183declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003184default-server X - X X
3185default_backend X X X -
3186description - X X X
3187disabled X X X X
3188dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003189email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003190email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003191email-alert mailers X X X X
3192email-alert myhostname X X X X
3193email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003194enabled X X X X
3195errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003196errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003197errorloc X X X X
3198errorloc302 X X X X
3199-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3200errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003201force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003202filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003203fullconn X - X X
3204grace X X X X
3205hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003206http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003207http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003208http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003209http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003210http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003211http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003212http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003213http-check set-var X - X X
3214http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003215http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003216http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003217http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003218http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003219http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003220id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003221ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003222load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003223log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003224log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003225log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003226log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003227max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003228maxconn X X X -
3229mode X X X X
3230monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003231monitor-uri X X X -
3232option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3233option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3234option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3235option allbackups (*) X - X X
3236option checkcache (*) X - X X
3237option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3238option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003239option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003240option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3241option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003242-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3243option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003244option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3245option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003246option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003247option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003248option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003249option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003250option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003251option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3252option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3253option httpchk X - X X
3254option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003255option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003256option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003257option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003258option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003259option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003260option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3261option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3262option logasap (*) X X X -
3263option mysql-check X - X X
3264option nolinger (*) X X X X
3265option originalto X X X X
3266option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003267option pgsql-check X - X X
3268option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003269option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003270option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003271option smtpchk X - X X
3272option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3273option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3274option splice-request (*) X X X X
3275option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003276option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003277option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3278option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3279-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003280option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003281option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3282option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3283option tcpka X X X X
3284option tcplog X X X X
3285option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003286external-check command X - X X
3287external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003288persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3289rate-limit sessions X X X -
3290redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003291-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003292retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003293retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003294server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003295server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003296server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003297source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003298srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3299srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3300srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003301stats admin - X X X
3302stats auth X X X X
3303stats enable X X X X
3304stats hide-version X X X X
3305stats http-request - X X X
3306stats realm X X X X
3307stats refresh X X X X
3308stats scope X X X X
3309stats show-desc X X X X
3310stats show-legends X X X X
3311stats show-node X X X X
3312stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003313-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3314stick match - - X X
3315stick on - - X X
3316stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003317stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003318stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003319tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003320tcp-check connect X - X X
3321tcp-check expect X - X X
3322tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003323tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003324tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003325tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003326tcp-check set-var X - X X
3327tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003328tcp-request connection - X X -
3329tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003330tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003331tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003332tcp-response content - - X X
3333tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003334timeout check X - X X
3335timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003336timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003337timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003338timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3339timeout http-request X X X X
3340timeout queue X - X X
3341timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003342timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003343timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003344timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003345transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003346unique-id-format X X X -
3347unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003348use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003349use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003350use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003351------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3352 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003353
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033554.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3356---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003357
3358This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3359
3360
3361acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3362 Declare or complete an access list.
3363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3364 no | yes | yes | yes
3365 Example:
3366 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3367 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3368 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003370 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003371
3372
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003373backlog <conns>
3374 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3376 yes | yes | yes | no
3377 Arguments :
3378 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3379 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003380 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003381
3382 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3383 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3384 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3385 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3386 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3387 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3388 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3389 backlog parameter.
3390
3391 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3392 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3393 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3394
3395 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3396
3397
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003398balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003399balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003400 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3402 yes | no | yes | yes
3403 Arguments :
3404 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3405 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3406 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3407 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3408
3409 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3410 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3411 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3412 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003413 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003414 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003415 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3416 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3417 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3418 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3419 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3420 it, so that you don't worry.
3421
3422 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3423 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3424 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3425 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3426 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3427 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3428 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3429 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003430
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003431 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3432 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3433 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3434 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3435 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3436 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3437 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003438 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3439 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3440 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003441
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003442 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003443 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003444 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3445 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003446 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003447 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3448 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3449 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3450 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3451 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003452 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3453 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3454 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3455 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3456 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3457 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003458
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003459 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3460 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3461 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3462 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3463 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3464 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3465 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3466 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003467 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003468 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003469 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3470 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3471 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003472
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003473 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3474 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3475 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3476 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3477 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3478 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3479 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3480 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3481 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3482 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3483 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3484 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003485
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003486 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003487 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3488 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3489 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3490 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3491 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3492 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3493 URIs start with a leading "/".
3494
3495 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3496 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3497 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3498 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3499
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003500 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3501 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3502 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3503 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3504
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003505 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003506 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3507
3508 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003509 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3510 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003511 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3512 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3513 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3514 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003515 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003516 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3517 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003518
3519 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3520 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3521 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3522 server will receive the request.
3523
3524 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3525 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3526 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3527 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3528 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003529 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3530 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3531 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003532
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003533 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3534 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3535 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3536 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3537 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003538
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003539 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003540 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3541 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3542 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3543
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003544 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3545 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3546 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3547
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003548 random
3549 random(<draws>)
3550 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003551 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3552 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3553 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3554 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003555 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3556 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3557 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3558 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3559 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3560 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3561 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3562 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3563 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3564 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3565 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3566 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3567 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3568 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3569 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3570 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3571 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3572 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3573 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3574 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003575
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003576 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003577 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003578 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3579 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3580 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3581 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3582 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3583 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003584 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003585 used instead.
3586
3587 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3588 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3589 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3590 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3591
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003592 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3593 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3594 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3595
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003596 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003597
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003598 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003599 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3600 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003601
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003602 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3603 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3604 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003605
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003606 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003607 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003608 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3609 NTLM relies on.
3610
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003611 Examples :
3612 balance roundrobin
3613 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003614 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003615 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3616 balance hdr(host)
3617 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003618
3619 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3620 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3621
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003622 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003623 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3624 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3625 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003626 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003627
3628 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3629 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3630 defaults to 16 kB.
3631
3632 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3633 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3634
3635 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3636 Round Robin.
3637
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003638 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003639 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3640 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3641 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3642
3643 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3644
3645 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003646 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003647 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3648 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3649 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003650
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003651 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003652
3653
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003654bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3655bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003656 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3658 no | yes | yes | no
3659 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003660 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3661 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3662 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3663 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003664 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003665 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3666 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3667 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3668 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3669 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3670 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003671 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003672 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3673 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003674 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003675 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3676 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003677 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003678 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3679 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003680 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003681 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3682 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3683 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3684 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3685 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3686 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3687 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003688 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3689 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3690 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003691 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3692 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3693 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3694 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003695 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3696 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3697 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003698
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003699 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3700 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003701 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3702 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3703 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003704 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3705 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3706 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3707 the range.
3708
3709 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3710 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3711 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3712 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3713 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3714 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3715 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003716 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003717 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003718
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003719 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003720 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003721 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3722 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3723 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3724 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3725 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3726 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3727
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003728 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3729 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3730 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3731 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003732
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003733 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3734 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3735 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3736 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3737 in a frontend.
3738
3739 Example :
3740 listen http_proxy
3741 bind :80,:443
3742 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003743 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003744
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003745 listen http_https_proxy
3746 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003747 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003748
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003749 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3750 bind ipv6@:80
3751 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3752 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3753
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003754 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003755 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003756
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003757 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3758 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3759 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3760 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3761 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3762
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003763 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003764 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003765
3766
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003767bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003768 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3770 yes | yes | yes | yes
3771 Arguments :
3772 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3773 may be used to override a default value.
3774
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003775 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003776 option may be combined with other numbers.
3777
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003778 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003779 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3780 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3781 missing from all processes.
3782
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003783 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003784 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003785 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3786 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3787 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3788 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3789 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003790 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003791
3792 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3793 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3794 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3795 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3796 and 'even' instances.
3797
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003798 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3799 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3800 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3801 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003802
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003803 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3804 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3805
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003806 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3807 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3808 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3809
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003810 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3811 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3812
3813 Example :
3814 listen app_ip1
3815 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003816 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003817
3818 listen app_ip2
3819 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003820 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003821
3822 listen management
3823 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003824 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003825
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003826 listen management
3827 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3828 bind-process 1-4
3829
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003830 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003831
3832
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003833capture cookie <name> len <length>
3834 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3836 no | yes | yes | no
3837 Arguments :
3838 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3839 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3840 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3841 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003842 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003843
3844 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3845 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3846 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3847 right if it exceeds <length>.
3848
3849 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3850 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3851 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3852 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3853
3854 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3855 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3856 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3857
3858 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3859 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3860 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003861 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3862 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3863 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003864
3865 Example:
3866 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3867
3868 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003869 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003870
3871
3872capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003873 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3875 no | yes | yes | no
3876 Arguments :
3877 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003878 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003879 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3880 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3881 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3882
3883 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3884 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3885 it exceeds <length>.
3886
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003887 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003888 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3889 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003890 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3891 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3892 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3893 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003894 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003895 environments to find where the request came from.
3896
3897 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3898 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3899 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3900 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003901
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003902 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3903 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3904 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3905 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3906 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003907
3908 Example:
3909 capture request header Host len 15
3910 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003911 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003913 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003914 about logging.
3915
3916
3917capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003918 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3920 no | yes | yes | no
3921 Arguments :
3922 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003923 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003924 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3925 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3926 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3927
3928 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3929 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3930 it exceeds <length>.
3931
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003932 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003933 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3934 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3935 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003936 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3937 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3938 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3939 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003940
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003941 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3942 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3943 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3944 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3945 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003946
3947 Example:
3948 capture response header Content-length len 9
3949 capture response header Location len 15
3950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003951 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003952 about logging.
3953
3954
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003955clitcpka-cnt <count>
3956 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3957 the connection on the client side.
3958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3959 yes | yes | yes | no
3960 Arguments :
3961 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3962
3963 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3964 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003965 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3966 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003967
3968 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3969
3970
3971clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3972 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3973 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3974 client side.
3975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3976 yes | yes | yes | no
3977 Arguments :
3978 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3979 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3980 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
3981 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
3982
3983 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
3984 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003985 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3986 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003987
3988 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
3989
3990
3991clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
3992 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
3993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3994 yes | yes | yes | no
3995 Arguments :
3996 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
3997 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
3998 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
3999 document.
4000
4001 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4002 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004003 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4004 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004005
4006 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4007
4008
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004009compression algo <algorithm> ...
4010compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004011compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004012 Enable HTTP compression.
4013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4014 yes | yes | yes | yes
4015 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004016 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4017 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4018 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4019
4020 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004021 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4022 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4023 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004024
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004025 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004026 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004027
4028 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4029 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4030 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4031 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4032 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004033 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004034
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004035 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4036 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4037 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4038 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4039 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4040 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4041 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004042 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004043
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004044 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004045 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004046 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4047 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4048 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4049 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4050 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004051
4052 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4053 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4054 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4055 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4056 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004057 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4058 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4059 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4060 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4061 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004062 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4063 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004064
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004065 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004066 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4067 "Accept-Encoding" header
4068 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004069 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004070 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4071 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4072 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4073 "multipart"
4074 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4075 header
4076 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4077 and later
4078 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4079 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004080 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004081
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004082 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004083
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004084 Examples :
4085 compression algo gzip
4086 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004087
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004088
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004089cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004090 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4091 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004092 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004093 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4095 yes | no | yes | yes
4096 Arguments :
4097 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4098 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4099 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4100 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4101 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4102 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004103 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004104 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4105 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4106
4107 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4108 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4109 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4110 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4111 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4112 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004113 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4114 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004115 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004116 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4117 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004118
4119 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004120 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004121
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004122 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004123 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004124 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004125 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004126 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4127 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4128 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4129 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4130 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4131 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4132 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004133
4134 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4135 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4136 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4137 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4138 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4139 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4140 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4141 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4142 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004143 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004144 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4145 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4146 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004147
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004148 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4149 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4150 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004151 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4152 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4153 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4154 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004155 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4156 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4157 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004158
4159 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4160 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4161 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4162 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4163 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4164 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4165 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4166 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4167 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4168
4169 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4170 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4171 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4172 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4173 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4174 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4175 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4176 persistence cookie in the cache.
4177 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4178
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004179 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4180 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4181 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4182 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4183 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004184 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004185 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4186 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4187 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4188 they logout.
4189
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004190 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4191 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4192 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4193 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4194
4195 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4196 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4197 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4198 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4199 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4200 this attribute.
4201
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004202 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004203 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004204 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4205 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4206 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4207 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4208 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4209 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004210
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004211 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4212 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4213 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4214 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4215 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4216 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4217 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4218 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004219 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004220 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4221 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4222 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4223 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4224 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4225 the site.
4226
4227 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4228 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4229 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4230 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4231 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4232 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4233 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4234 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4235 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4236 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4237 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4238 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4239 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004240 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004241 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4242 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4243
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004244 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4245 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4246 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4247 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4248 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4249 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4250
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004251 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4252 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4253 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4254 repeated.
4255
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004256 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4257 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4258 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4259 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004260
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004261 Examples :
4262 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4263 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4264 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004265 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004266
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004267 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004268
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004269
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004270declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4271 Declares a capture slot.
4272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4273 no | yes | yes | no
4274 Arguments:
4275 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4276
4277 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4278 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4279 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4280 for use in the response.
4281
4282 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004283 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004284 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4285
4286
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004287default-server [param*]
4288 Change default options for a server in a backend
4289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4290 yes | no | yes | yes
4291 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004292 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4293 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4294 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4295 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004296
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004297 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004298 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4299
4300 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004301
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004302
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004303default_backend <backend>
4304 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4306 yes | yes | yes | no
4307 Arguments :
4308 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4309
4310 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4311 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4312 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4313 will catch all undetermined requests.
4314
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004315 Example :
4316
4317 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4318 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4319 default_backend dynamic
4320
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004321 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004323
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004324description <string>
4325 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4327 no | yes | yes | yes
4328 Arguments : string
4329
4330 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4331 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4332 it describes.
4333 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4334
4335
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004336disabled
4337 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4339 yes | yes | yes | yes
4340 Arguments : none
4341
4342 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4343 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4344 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4345 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4346 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4347 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4348 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4349
4350 See also : "enabled"
4351
4352
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004353dispatch <address>:<port>
4354 Set a default server address
4355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4356 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004357 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004358
4359 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4360 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4361 during start-up.
4362
4363 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4364 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4365 possible with normal servers.
4366
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004367 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004368 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4369 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4370 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4371 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4372
4373 See also : "server"
4374
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004375
4376dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4377 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4379 yes | no | yes | yes
4380 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4381
4382 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004383 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004384 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4385 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004386 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004387 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004388
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004389enabled
4390 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4392 yes | yes | yes | yes
4393 Arguments : none
4394
4395 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4396 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4397
4398 See also : "disabled"
4399
4400
4401errorfile <code> <file>
4402 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4404 yes | yes | yes | yes
4405 Arguments :
4406 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004407 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004408 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004409
4410 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004411 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004412 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004413 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4414 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004415
4416 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4417 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4418 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4419
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004420 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4421
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004422 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4423 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4424 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4425 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4426 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4427 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4428 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4429 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4430 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004431
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004432 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4433 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4434 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004435 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004436 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4437
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004438 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004439
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004440 Example :
4441 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004442 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004443 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4444 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4445
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004446
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004447errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4448 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4449 section.
4450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4451 yes | yes | yes | yes
4452 Arguments :
4453 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4454
4455 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004456 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004457 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004458
4459 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4460 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4461 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4462 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4463 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004464 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004465 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4466
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004467 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4468 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004469
4470 Example :
4471 errorfiles generic
4472 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4473
4474
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004475errorloc <code> <url>
4476errorloc302 <code> <url>
4477 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4479 yes | yes | yes | yes
4480 Arguments :
4481 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004482 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004483 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004484
4485 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4486 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4487 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4488 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004489 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004490
4491 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4492 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4493 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4494
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004495 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4496
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004497 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4498 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4499 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4500 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004501 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004502 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4503 request.
4504
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004505 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004506
4507
4508errorloc303 <code> <url>
4509 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4511 yes | yes | yes | yes
4512 Arguments :
4513 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004514 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004515 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004516
4517 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4518 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4519 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4520 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004521 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004522
4523 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4524 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4525 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4526
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004527 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4528
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004529 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4530 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4531 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4532 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004533 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004534
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004535 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004536
4537
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004538email-alert from <emailaddr>
4539 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004540 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004541 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4542 yes | yes | yes | yes
4543
4544 Arguments :
4545
4546 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4547
4548 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4549 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4550
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004551 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004552 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4553 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004554
4555
4556email-alert level <level>
4557 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4558 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4559 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4560 yes | yes | yes | yes
4561
4562 Arguments :
4563
4564 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4565 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4566 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4567
4568 By default level is alert
4569
4570 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4571 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4572 for the proxy.
4573
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004574 Alerts are sent when :
4575
4576 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4577 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4578 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4579 is notice or lower
4580 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4581 and a health check status update occurs
4582
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004583 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4584 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004585 section 3.6 about mailers.
4586
4587
4588email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4589 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4590 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4591 yes | yes | yes | yes
4592
4593 Arguments :
4594
4595 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4596
4597 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4598 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4599
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004600 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4601 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004602
4603
4604email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4605 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4606 mailers.
4607 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4608 yes | yes | yes | yes
4609
4610 Arguments :
4611
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004612 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004613
4614 By default the systems hostname is used.
4615
4616 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4617 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4618 for the proxy.
4619
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004620 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4621 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004622
4623
4624email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004625 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004626 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4627 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4628 yes | yes | yes | yes
4629
4630 Arguments :
4631
4632 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4633
4634 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4635 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4636
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004637 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004638 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4639
4640
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004641force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4642 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4643 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004644 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004645
4646 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4647 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4648 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4649 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4650 marked down for maintenance operations.
4651
4652 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4653 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4654 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4655 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4656 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4657 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4658 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4659 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4660 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4661
4662 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4663 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4664 is used.
4665
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004666 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004667 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004668
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004669
4670filter <name> [param*]
4671 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4673 no | yes | yes | yes
4674 Arguments :
4675 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4676 referenced in section 9.
4677
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004678 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004679 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004680 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4681 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004682
4683 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4684 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4685
4686 Example:
4687 listen
4688 bind *:80
4689
4690 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4691 filter compression
4692 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4693
4694 compression algo gzip
4695 compression offload
4696
4697 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4698
4699 See also : section 9.
4700
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004701
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004702fullconn <conns>
4703 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4705 yes | no | yes | yes
4706 Arguments :
4707 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4708 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4709
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004710 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004711 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004712 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004713 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4714 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4715 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4716 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4717 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004718 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004719
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004720 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4721 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004722 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4723 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4724 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004725
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004726 Example :
4727 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4728 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4729 # connections.
4730 backend dynamic
4731 fullconn 10000
4732 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4733 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4734
4735 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4736
4737
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004738grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004739 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004741 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004742 Arguments :
4743 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4744 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4745 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4746
4747 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4748 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004749 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004750 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4751
4752 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4753 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4754 simplify it.
4755
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004756
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004757hash-balance-factor <factor>
4758 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4760 yes | no | no | yes
4761 Arguments :
4762 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4763 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004764 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004765
4766 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4767 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4768 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4769 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4770 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4771 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4772 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4773
4774 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4775 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4776 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4777 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4778 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4779
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004780 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4781 consistent hashing mechanism.
4782
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004783 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4784
4785
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004786hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004787 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4789 yes | no | yes | yes
4790 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004791 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4792 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004793
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004794 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4795 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4796 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4797 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4798 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4799 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4800 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4801 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4802 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4803 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004804
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004805 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4806 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4807 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4808 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4809 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4810 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4811 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4812 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4813 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4814 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4815 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4816 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4817 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004818 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4819 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004820
4821 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4822
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004823 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004824 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4825 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4826 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004827 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4828 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4829 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004830
4831 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4832 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004833 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4834 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4835 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4836 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4837
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004838 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4839 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4840 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4841 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4842 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4843 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4844 parameter.
4845
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004846 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4847 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4848 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4849 used on strings.
4850
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004851 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4852
4853 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4854 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4855 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4856 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4857 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4858 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4859 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4860 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4861 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4862 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4863 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4864 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004865
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004866 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4867 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4868 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004869
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004870 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004871
4872
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004873http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4874 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4875 ones).
4876
4877 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4878 no | yes | yes | yes
4879
4880 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4881 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4882 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4883 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4884 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4885 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4886
4887 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4888 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4889 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4890
4891 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4892 below.
4893
4894 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4895 instance.
4896
4897 Example:
4898 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4899 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4900 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4901
4902http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4903
4904 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4905 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4906 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4907 example, or to pass some internal information.
4908 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4909 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4910 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4911
4912http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4913
4914 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4915 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4916
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004917http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004918
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004919 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
4920 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
4921 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
4922 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
4923 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004924
4925http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4926 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4927
4928 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4929
4930 Example:
4931 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4932
4933 # applied to:
4934 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4935
4936 # outputs:
4937 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4938
4939 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4940
4941http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4942 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4943
4944 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4945
4946 Example:
4947 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4948
4949 # applied to:
4950 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4951
4952 # outputs:
4953 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4954
4955http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4956
4957 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4958 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4959 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4960
4961http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4962 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4963
4964 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4965 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4966 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4967 fallback.
4968
4969 Example:
4970 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4971 http-response set-status 431
4972 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4973 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4974
4975http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4976
4977 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4978 inline.
4979
4980 Arguments:
4981 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4982 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4983 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4984 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4985 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4986 (request and response)
4987 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4988 processing
4989 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4990 processing
4991 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4992 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4993 and '_'.
4994
4995 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4996 followed by some converters.
4997
4998 Example:
4999 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5000
5001http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5002
5003 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5004 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5005 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5006 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5007 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005008 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005009 processing.
5010
5011 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5012 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005013 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005014 rules evaluation.
5015
5016http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5017
5018 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5019 details about <var-name>.
5020
5021 Example:
5022 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5023
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005024
5025http-check comment <string>
5026 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5027 it fails.
5028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5029 yes | no | yes | yes
5030
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005031 Arguments :
5032 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5033 rule fails.
5034
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005035 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5036 user-friendly error reporting.
5037
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005038 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005039 "http-check expect".
5040
5041
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005042http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5043 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005044 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005045 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5047 yes | no | yes | yes
5048
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005049 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005050 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5051
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005052 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005053 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005054
5055 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5056 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5057 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5058 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5059
5060 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5061
5062 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5063
5064 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5065
5066 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5067
5068 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5069
5070 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5071 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5072 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5073 is used.
5074
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005075 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5076 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5077 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5078 haproxy -vv.
5079
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005080 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5081
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005082 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5083 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5084 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5085 different ports or with different servers.
5086
5087 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5088 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5089 the port with a "http-check connect".
5090
5091 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5092 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5093 do.
5094
5095 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5096 unset-var or comment rules.
5097
5098 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005099 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5100 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5101 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5102 option httpchk
5103
5104 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005105 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005106 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005107 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005108 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005109 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005110
5111 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5112
5113 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005114
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005116http-check disable-on-404
5117 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005119 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005120 Arguments : none
5121
5122 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5123 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5124 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5125 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5126 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5127 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5128 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5129 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005130 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5131 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005132 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5133 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5134 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005135
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005136 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005137
5138
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005139http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005140 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5141 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5142 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005143 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005145 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005146
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005147 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005148 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5149
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005150 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5151 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5152 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5153 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5154 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5155 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5156 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5157 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5158 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5159 result is always conclusive.
5160
5161 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5162 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5163 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005164 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5165 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005166 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5167 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005168 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5169 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5170 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005171
5172 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5173 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005174 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5175 supported :
5176 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5177 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005178 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5179 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5180 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5181 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5182 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005183
5184 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5185 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005186 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5187 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5188 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5189 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005190 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5191
5192 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5193 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5194 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5195 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5196
5197 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5198 informational message reported in logs if an error
5199 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5200 log-format string.
5201
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005202 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005203 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5204 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005205 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5206 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5207 details on the supported keywords.
5208
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005209 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5210 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5211 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5212 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005213
5214 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5215 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5216 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5217 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5218 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5219
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005220 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5221 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5222 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5223 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5224 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5225 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5226 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005227
5228 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005229 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005230 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5231 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5232 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5233 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5234
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005235 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5236 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005237 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5238 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5239 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5240 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5241 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5242 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5243 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5244 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005245 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5246 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5247 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5248 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5249 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5250 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5251 insensitive on the header names.
5252
5253 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5254 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5255 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5256 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5257 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5258 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005259
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005260 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005261 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005262 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5263 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5264 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5265 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5266 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005267 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005268 trace).
5269
5270 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005271 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005272 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5273 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5274 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5275 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5276 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005277 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005278
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005279 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5280 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5281 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5282 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5283 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5284 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5285
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005286 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005287 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005288 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5289 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5290 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5291 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5292 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5293 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5294
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005295 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5296 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5297 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5298 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5299 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005300
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005301 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5302 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5303
5304 Examples :
5305 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005306 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005307
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005308 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5309 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005311 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005312 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005313
5314 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005315 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005316
5317 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005318 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005319
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005320 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005321 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005322
5323
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005324http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005325 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5326 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005327 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5328 health checks.
5329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5330 yes | no | yes | yes
5331 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005332 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5333
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005334 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5335 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5336 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5337 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5338 to invent non-standard ones.
5339
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005340 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5341 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5342 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5343 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5344
5345 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5346 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5347 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5348 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005349
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005350 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005351 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005352 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005353 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5354 to add it.
5355
5356 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5357 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5358 to the log-format rules.
5359
5360 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5361 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5362 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005363
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005364 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5365 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5366 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5367 request.
5368
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005369 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5370 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5371 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005372 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5373 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5374 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5375 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005376 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005377 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005378 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
5379
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005380 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
5381 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005382 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
5383 so, it will be ignored.
5384
5385 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5386 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5387 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5388 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5389 configured request authority.
5390
5391 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5392 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005393
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005394 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005395
5396
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005397http-check send-state
5398 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5400 yes | no | yes | yes
5401 Arguments : none
5402
5403 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5404 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5405 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5406 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5407 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5408
5409 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5410 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5411 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5412 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5413 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005414 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5415 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5416 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5417
5418 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5419 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5420 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5421
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005422 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5423 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5424 checked in multiple backends.
5425
5426 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5427 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5428
5429 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5430 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5431 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5432 one fails.
5433
5434 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5435 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5436 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5437
5438 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5439 server's queue.
5440
5441 Example of a header received by the application server :
5442 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5443 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5444
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005445 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5446 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005447
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005448
5449http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005450 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005451 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5452 yes | no | yes | yes
5453
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005454 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005455 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5456 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5457 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5458 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5459 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5460 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5461 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5462 and '-'.
5463
5464 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5465
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005466 Examples :
5467 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005468
5469
5470http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005471 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005472 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5473 yes | no | yes | yes
5474
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005475 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005476 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5477 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5478 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5479 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5480 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5481 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5482 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5483 and '-'.
5484
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005485 Examples :
5486 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005487
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005488
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005489http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5490 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5491 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5492 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5493 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5495 yes | yes | yes | yes
5496 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005497 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005498 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005499 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5500 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005501
5502 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5503 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5504 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5505 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5506
5507 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5508 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5509 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5510 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5511
5512 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5513 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5514 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5515 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5516 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5517 chroot is performed.
5518
5519 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5520 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5521 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5522 considered.
5523
5524 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5525 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5526 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5527 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5528 considered as a raw string.
5529
5530 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5531 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5532 "content-type".
5533
5534 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5535 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5536 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5537 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5538 evaluated as a log-format string.
5539
5540 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5541 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5542 argument to "content-type".
5543
5544 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5545 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5546 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5547 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5548
5549 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5550 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5551 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5552 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5553 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5554 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5555 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5556 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5557
5558 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5559 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5560 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5561
5562 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5563 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5564
5565
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005566http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005567 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5568
5569 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5570 no | yes | yes | yes
5571
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005572 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5573 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5574 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5575 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5576 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005577
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005578 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5579 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005580
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005581 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005582
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005583 Example:
5584 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5585 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5586 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005587
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005588 http-request allow if nagios
5589 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5590 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5591 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005592
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005593 Example:
5594 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5595 acl add path /addacl
5596 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005597
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005598 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005600 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5601 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005602
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005603 Example:
5604 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5605 acl setmap path /setmap
5606 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005608 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005609
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005610 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5611 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005613 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5614 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005616http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005617
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005618 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5619 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5620 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5621 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5622 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5623 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5624 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5625 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005627http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005629 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5630 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5631 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5632 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5633 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5634 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5635 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5636 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005638http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005639
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005640 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5641 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005642
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005643
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005644http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005646 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5647 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5648 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5649 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5650 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005651
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005652 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5653 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5654 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5655 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5656 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5657 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5658 instead.
5659
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005660 Example:
5661 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5662 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005663
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005664http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005665
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005666 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005667
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005668http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5669 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005671 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5672 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5673 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5674 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5675 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5676 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5677 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5678 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5679 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005680
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005681 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5682 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5683 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005684 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5685
5686 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5687 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5688 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5689 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005691http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005693 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5694 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5695 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5696 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5697 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5698 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005699
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005700http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005701
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005702 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5703 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5704 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5705 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5706 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005707
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005708http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005709
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005710 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5711 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5712 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5713 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5714 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5715 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005716
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005717http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5718http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5719 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5720 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5721 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5722 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005723
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005724 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5725 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5726 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005727 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005728 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5729 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5730 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005731 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005732 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005733
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005734http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5735 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5736 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5737 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5738
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005739http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5740
5741 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5742 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5743 pointed by <resolvers>.
5744 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5745 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5746 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5747 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5748 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5749 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5750 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5751 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5752 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5753 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5754 to 0.0.0.0.
5755
5756 Example:
5757 resolvers mydns
5758 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5759 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5760 timeout retry 1s
5761 hold valid 10s
5762 hold nx 3s
5763 hold other 3s
5764 hold obsolete 0s
5765 accepted_payload_size 8192
5766
5767 frontend fe
5768 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5769 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5770 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5771
5772 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5773 # which mean DNS resolution error
5774 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5775
5776 default_backend be
5777
5778 backend b_503
5779 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5780 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5781 # 503 error page to end users
5782
5783 backend be
5784 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5785 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5786 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5787 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5788 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5789
5790 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5791 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5792
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005793http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5794
5795 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5796 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5797 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5798 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005799 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5800 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005801
5802 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5803
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005804http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005805
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005806 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5807 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5808 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5809 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5810 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005811
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005812http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005813
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005814 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5815 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5816 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5817 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005818
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005819http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5820 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005821
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005822 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005823 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5824 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5825 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5826 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5827 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005828
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005829 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5830 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5831 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5832 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5833 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005834
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005835 Example:
5836 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5837
5838 # applied to:
5839 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5840
5841 # outputs:
5842 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5843
5844 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005845
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005846 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5847
5848 # applied to:
5849 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005850
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005851 # outputs:
5852 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005853
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005854http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5855 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5856
5857 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5858 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005859 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5860 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5861 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005862
5863 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5864 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5865 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5866
5867 Example:
5868 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5869 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5870
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005871 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5872 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5873 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5874 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5875
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005876http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5877 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5878
5879 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5880 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5881 query-string are replaced.
5882
5883 Example:
5884 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5885 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5886
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005887http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5888 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5889
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005890 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5891 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5892 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5893 against.
5894
5895 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5896 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5897 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005898
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005899 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5900 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5901 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5902 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5903 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5904 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5905 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5906 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5907 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005908 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5909 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005910
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005911 Example:
5912 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5913 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005914
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005915 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5916 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005917
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005918http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5919 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005920
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005921 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5922 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5923 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5924 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005925
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005926 Example:
5927 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005928
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005929 # applied to:
5930 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005931
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005932 # outputs:
5933 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005934
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005935http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5936 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5937 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005938 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005939 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5940
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005941 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005942 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5943 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005944 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005945 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005946 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005947 are followed to create the response :
5948
5949 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5950 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5951 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5952 ignored.
5953
5954 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5955 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005956 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005957 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5958 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005959
5960 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5961 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5962 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005963 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005964 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005965
5966 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5967 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5968 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005969 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005970 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5971 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005972
5973 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5974 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5975 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5976 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5977 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5978 as a raw content.
5979
5980 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5981 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5982 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5983 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5984 considered as a raw string.
5985
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005986 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005987 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5988 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5989 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5990
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005991 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5992 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005993 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005994
5995 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5996
5997 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005998 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005999 if { path /ping }
6000
6001 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6002 if { path /favicon.ico }
6003
6004 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6005 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6006 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6007
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006008http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6009http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006010
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006011 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6012 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6013 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006014
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006015http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6016 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006017
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006018 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6019 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6020 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6021 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006022
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006023http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006024
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006025 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6026 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6027 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6028 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6029 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006030
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006031 Arguments:
6032 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6033 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006034
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006035 Example:
6036 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6037 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006038
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006039 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6040 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006041
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006042http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006043
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006044 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6045 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6046 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006047
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006048 Arguments:
6049 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6050 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006051
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006052 Example:
6053 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6054 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006056 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6057 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6058 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006059
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006060http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006062 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6063 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6064 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6065 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6066 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006067
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006068 Example:
6069 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6070 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6071 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6072 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6073 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6074 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6075 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6076 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6077 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006078
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006079http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006080
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006081 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6082 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6083 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6084 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6085 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006086
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006087http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6088 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006089
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006090 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6091 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6092 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6093 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6094 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6095 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6096 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6097 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6098 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006099
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006100http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006102 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6103 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6104 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6105 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6106 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6107 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6108 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006109
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006110http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006112 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6113 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6114 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006115
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006116http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006117
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006118 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6119 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6120 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6121 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6122 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6123 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6124 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6125 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006126
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006127http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006128
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006129 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6130 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6131 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6132 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6133 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6134 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006135
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006136 Example :
6137 # prepend the host name before the path
6138 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006139
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006140http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6141
6142 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6143 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6144 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6145
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006146http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006147
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006148 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6149 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6150 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6151 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6152 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006153
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006154http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006156 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6157 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6158 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6159 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6160 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6161 values have higher priority.
6162 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6163 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6164 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6165 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6166 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006167
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006168http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006169
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006170 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6171 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6172 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6173 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6174 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6175 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6176 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006177
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006178 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006179
6180 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006181 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6182 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006183
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006184http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6185 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6186 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6187 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006188 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6189 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006190
6191 Arguments :
6192 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6193 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006194
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006195 See also "option forwardfor".
6196
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006197 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006198 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6199 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6200
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006201 # After the masking this will track connections
6202 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6203 http-request track-sc0 src
6204
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006205 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6206 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6207
6208http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6209
6210 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6211 expression.
6212
6213 Arguments:
6214 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6215 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006216
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006217 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006218 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6219 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6220
6221 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6222 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6223 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6224
6225http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6226
6227 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6228 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6229 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6230 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6231 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6232 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6233 information from the request.
6234
6235 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6236
6237http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6238
6239 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6240 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6241 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6242 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6243 path and the query string.
6244 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6245
6246http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6247
6248 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6249 inline.
6250
6251 Arguments:
6252 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6253 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6254 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6255 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6256 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6257 (request and response)
6258 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6259 processing
6260 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6261 processing
6262 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6263 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6264 and '_'.
6265
6266 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6267 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006268
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006269 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006270 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006271
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006272http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6273 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006274
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006275 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6276 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6277 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6278 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6279 agent name must be used.
6280
6281 Arguments:
6282 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6283
6284 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6285 configuration.
6286
6287http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6288
6289 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6290 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6291 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6292 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6293 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6294 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6295 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6296 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6297 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6298 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6299 action.
6300 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6301 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6302 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6303 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6304 you fully understand how it works.
6305
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006306http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6307
6308 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6309 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6310 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6311 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6312 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006313 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006314 processing.
6315
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006316 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006317 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6318 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6319 rules evaluation.
6320
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006321http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6322http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6323 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6324 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6325 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6326 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006327
6328 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6329 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6330 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006331 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6332 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6333 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6334 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6335 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6336 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6337 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6338 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6339 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6340 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006341 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006342 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6343 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6344 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6345 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6346 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006347
6348http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6349http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6350http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6351
6352 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6353 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6354 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6355 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006356 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006357 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6358 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6359 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6360 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6361 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6362 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6363 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6364
6365 Arguments :
6366 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6367 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6368 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6369 select which table entry to update the counters.
6370
6371 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6372 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6373 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6374 that table until the session ends.
6375
6376 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6377 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6378 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6379 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6380 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6381 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6382 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6383 useful information.
6384
6385 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6386 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6387 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6388 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6389 checks that make use of it.
6390
6391http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6392
6393 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006394
6395 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006396 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006397
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006398http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6399
6400 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6401 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6402 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6403 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6404 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6405 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6406
6407 Arguments :
6408 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6409
6410 Example:
6411 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6412
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006413http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006414
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006415 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6416 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6417 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006418
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006419
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006420http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006421 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6422
6423 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6424 no | yes | yes | yes
6425
6426 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6427 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6428 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6429 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6430 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6431 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6432
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006433 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6434 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006435
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006436 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006437
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006438 Example:
6439 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006440
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006441 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006442
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006443 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6444 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006445
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006446 Example:
6447 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006448
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006449 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006450
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006451 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6452 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006453
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006454 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6455 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006456
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006457http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006458
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006459 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6460 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6461 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6462 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6463 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6464 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6465 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6466 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006467
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006468http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006469
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006470 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6471 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6472 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6473 example, or to pass some internal information.
6474 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6475 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6476 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006477
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006478http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006479
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006480 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6481 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006482
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006483http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006484
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006485 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006486
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006487http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006488
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006489 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6490 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6491 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6492 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6493 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6494 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6495 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006496
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006497 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6498 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6499 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6500 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6501 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006502
6503 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6504 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6505 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6506 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006507
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006508http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006509
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006510 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6511 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6512 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6513 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6514 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6515 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006516
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006517http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006518
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006519 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6520 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6521 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6522 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6523 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006524
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006525http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006526
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006527 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6528 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6529 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6530 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6531 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6532 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006533
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006534http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6535http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6536 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6537 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6538 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6539 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006540
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006541 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6542 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6543 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006544 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006545 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6546 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6547 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006548 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006549 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006550
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006551http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006552
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006553 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6554 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6555 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6556 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6557 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6558 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006559
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006560http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6561 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006562
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006563 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6564 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006565
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006566 Example:
6567 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006568
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006569 # applied to:
6570 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006571
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006572 # outputs:
6573 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006574
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006575 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006576
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006577http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6578 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006579
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006580 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006581 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006582
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006583 Example:
6584 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006585
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006586 # applied to:
6587 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006588
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006589 # outputs:
6590 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006591
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006592http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6593 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6594 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006595 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006596 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6597
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006598 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006599 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6600 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006601 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006602 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006603 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006604 are followed to create the response :
6605
6606 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6607 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6608 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6609 ignored.
6610
6611 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6612 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006613 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006614 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6615 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006616
6617 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6618 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6619 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006620 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006621 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006622
6623 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6624 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6625 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006626 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006627 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6628 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006629
6630 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6631 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6632 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6633 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6634 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6635 as a raw content.
6636
6637 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6638 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6639 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6640 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6641 considered as a raw string.
6642
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006643 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6644 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6645 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6646 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6647
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006648 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6649 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006650 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006651
6652 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6653
6654 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006655 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006656 if { status eq 404 }
6657
6658 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6659 string "This is the end !" \
6660 if { status eq 500 }
6661
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006662http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6663http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006664
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006665 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6666 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6667 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006668
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006669http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6670 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006671
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006672 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6673 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6674 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6675 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006676
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006677http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006678
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006679 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6680 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6681 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6682 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6683 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006684
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006685 Arguments:
6686 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006687
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006688 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6689 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006690
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006691http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006692
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006693 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6694 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6695 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006696
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006697http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6698
6699 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6700 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6701 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6702 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6703 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6704
6705http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6706
6707 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6708 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6709 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6710 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6711 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6712 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6713 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6714 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6715 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6716
6717http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6718
6719 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6720 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6721 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6722 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6723 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6724 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6725 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6726
6727http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6728
6729 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6730 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6731 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6732 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6733 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6734 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6735 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6736 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6737
6738http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6739 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6740
6741 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6742 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6743 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6744 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006745
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006746 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006747 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6748 http-response set-status 431
6749 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6750 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006751
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006752http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006753
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006754 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6755 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6756 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6757 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6758 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6759 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6760 based on some information from the request.
6761
6762 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6763
6764http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6765
6766 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6767 inline.
6768
6769 Arguments:
6770 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6771 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6772 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6773 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6774 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6775 (request and response)
6776 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6777 processing
6778 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6779 processing
6780 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6781 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6782 and '_'.
6783
6784 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6785 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006786
6787 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006788 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006789
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006790http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006791
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006792 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6793 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6794 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6795 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6796 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6797 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6798 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6799 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6800 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6801 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6802 action.
6803 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6804 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6805 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6806 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6807 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006808
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006809http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6810
6811 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6812 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6813 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6814 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6815 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006816 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006817 processing.
6818
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006819 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006820 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006821 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006822 rules evaluation.
6823
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006824http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6825http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6826http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006827
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006828 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6829 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6830 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6831 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6832 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6833 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6834
6835http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6836
6837 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6838 about <var-name>.
6839
6840 Example:
6841 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6842
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006843
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006844http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6845 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6846
6847 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6848 yes | no | yes | yes
6849
6850 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006851 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6852 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6853 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006854
6855 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6856
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006857 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6858 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6859 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6860 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6861 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6862 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6863 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6864 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6865 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6866 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006867
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006868 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6869 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6870 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6871 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6872 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6873 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6874 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02006875 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
6876 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
6877 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
6878 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
6879 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
6880 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006881
6882 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6883 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6884 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6885 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6886 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6887 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6888 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6889 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006890 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006891 downsides of rare connection failures.
6892
6893 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6894 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6895 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6896 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6897 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6898 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006899 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006900 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6901 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6902 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6903 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6904 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6905
6906 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006907 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6908 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6909 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006910
Amaury Denoyelle7239c242020-10-15 16:41:09 +02006911 - connections sent to a server with a variable value as TLS SNI extension
6912 are marked private and are never shared. This is not the case if the SNI
6913 is guaranteed to be a constant, as for example using a literal string;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006914
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006915 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6916 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006917
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006918 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006919
6920 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6921 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6922 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6923
6924 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6925
6926
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006927http-send-name-header [<header>]
6928 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006929 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6930 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006931 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006932 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6933
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006934 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6935 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6936 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6937 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6938 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6939 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6940 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6941 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6942 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6943 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6944 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6945 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6946 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6947 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6948 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6949 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006950
6951 See also : "server"
6952
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006953id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006954 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6956 no | yes | yes | yes
6957 Arguments : none
6958
6959 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6960 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6961 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006962
6963
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006964ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6965 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6966 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006967 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006968
6969 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6970 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6971 and running).
6972
6973 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6974 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6975 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006976 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006977 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6978
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006979 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6980 "unless" condition is met.
6981
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006982 Example:
6983 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6984 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6985 ignore-persist if url_static
6986
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006987 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6988
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006989load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6990 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6991 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6992 yes | no | yes | yes
6993
6994 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6995 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6996 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006997 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006998 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6999 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7000 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7001 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7002
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007003 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007004 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007005 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007006
7007 Arguments:
7008 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7009 named "server-state-file".
7010
7011 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7012 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7013 name is used as a file name.
7014
7015 none don't load any stat for this backend
7016
7017 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007018 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7019 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7020 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007021 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007022 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007023
7024 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7025 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7026
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007027 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007028
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007029 global
7030 stats socket /tmp/socket
7031 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007032
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007033 defaults
7034 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007035
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007036 backend bk
7037 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7038 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007039
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007040
7041 Then one can run :
7042
7043 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7044
7045 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7046
7047 1
7048 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7049 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7050 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7051
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007052 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007053
7054 global
7055 stats socket /tmp/socket
7056 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7057
7058 defaults
7059 load-server-state-from-file local
7060
7061 backend bk
7062 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7063 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7064
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007065
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007066 Then one can run :
7067
7068 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7069
7070 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7071
7072 1
7073 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7074 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7075 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7076
7077 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7078 "show servers state"
7079
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007080
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007081log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007082log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
7083 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007084no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007085 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7087 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007088
7089 Prefix :
7090 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7091 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7092 prefix does not allow arguments.
7093
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007094 Arguments :
7095 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7096 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7097 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7098 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7099 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7100 parameter.
7101
7102 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7103 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7104
7105 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7106 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7107 standard syslog port).
7108
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007109 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7110 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7111 standard syslog port).
7112
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007113 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7114 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7115 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007116 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007117
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007118 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7119 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7120 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7121 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7122 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7123 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7124 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7125 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7126 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7127 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7128 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7129 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7130 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7131 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7132 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7133 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007134 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7135 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007136
7137 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7138 and "fd@2", see above.
7139
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007140 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7141 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7142 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7143 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7144 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7145 having the logs instantly available.
7146
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007147 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7148 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007149
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007150 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7151 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7152 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7153 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7154 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7155 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7156 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7157 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7158 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7159 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007160 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007161
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007162 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7163 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7164 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7165 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7166 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7167
7168 <sample_size>
7169 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7170 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7171 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7172 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7173 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7174
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007175 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7176 one of the following :
7177
7178 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
7179 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7180
7181 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7182 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7183
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007184 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7185 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7186 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7187 designed to be used with a local log server.
7188
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007189 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7190 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7191 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7192 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7193 systemd logger consumes.
7194
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007195 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7196 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7197 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7198 used with a local log server.
7199
7200 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7201 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7202 designed to be used with a local log server.
7203
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007204 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7205 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7206 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7207 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7208
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007209 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7210
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007211 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7212 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7213 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7214
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007215 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7216 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7217 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7218 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007219
7220 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7221 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7222 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007223 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7224 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7225 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7226 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7227 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007228
7229 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7230
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007231 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7232 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7233 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007234
7235 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7236 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7237 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7238 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7239
7240 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7241 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007242
7243 Example :
7244 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007245 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7246 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7247 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007248 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
7249 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007250 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007251
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007252
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007253log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007254 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7255 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7256 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007257
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007258 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7259 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7260 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7261 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7262 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007263
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007264 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7265 "option httplog" directives.
7266
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007267log-format-sd <string>
7268 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7269 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7270 yes | yes | yes | no
7271
7272 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7273 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7274 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7275 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7276 which covers the log format string in depth.
7277
7278 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7279 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7280
7281 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7282 log format to "rfc5424".
7283
7284 Example :
7285 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7286
7287
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007288log-tag <string>
7289 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7290 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7291 yes | yes | yes | yes
7292
7293 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7294 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7295 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7296 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7297 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7298 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7299 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7300 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7301 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007302
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007303max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7304 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7305 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7306 yes | no | yes | yes
7307
7308 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7309 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7310 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7311 servers.
7312
7313 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7314 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7315 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7316 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7317 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007318 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007319 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7320 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7321 picking a different server.
7322
7323 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7324 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7325 even if they have to be queued.
7326
7327 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7328 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7329
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007330max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7331 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7332 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7333 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007334
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007335maxconn <conns>
7336 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7338 yes | yes | yes | no
7339 Arguments :
7340 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7341 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7342 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7343 closes.
7344
7345 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7346 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7347 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7348 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007349 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7350 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7351 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7352 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007353
7354 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7355 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7356 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7357
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007358 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7359 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007360
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007361 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7362
7363
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007364mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007365 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7367 yes | yes | yes | yes
7368 Arguments :
7369 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7370 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7371 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7372 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7373
7374 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7375 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7376 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7377 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7378 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7379
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007380 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7381 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7382 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007383
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007384 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007385 defaults http_instances
7386 mode http
7387
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007388
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007389monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007390 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7392 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007393 Arguments :
7394 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7395 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007396 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007397 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7398 backend and its backup.
7399
7400 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7401 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7402 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7403 servers in a list of backends.
7404
7405 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7406 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7407 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7408 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7409 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7410 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7411 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007412 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7413 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007414
7415 Example:
7416 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007417 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007418 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7419 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7420 monitor-uri /site_alive
7421 monitor fail if site_dead
7422
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007423 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007424
7425
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007426monitor-uri <uri>
7427 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7429 yes | yes | yes | no
7430 Arguments :
7431 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7432 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7433
7434 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7435 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7436 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7437 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7438 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7439 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7440 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7441 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7442
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007443 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007444 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7445 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7446 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7447 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7448 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7449 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007450
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007451 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7452 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7453 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7454 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7455
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007456 Example :
7457 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7458 frontend www
7459 mode http
7460 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7461
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007462 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007463
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007464
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007465option abortonclose
7466no option abortonclose
7467 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7469 yes | no | yes | yes
7470 Arguments : none
7471
7472 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7473 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7474 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7475 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007476 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007477 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7478 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7479 encountered while delivering the response.
7480
7481 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7482 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7483 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7484 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7485 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7486 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007487 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007488 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007489 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007490 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7491 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7492 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7493
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007494 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7495 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007496 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7497 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7498 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7499 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7500 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7501 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007502 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007503
7504 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7505 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7506
7507 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7508
7509
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007510option accept-invalid-http-request
7511no option accept-invalid-http-request
7512 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7514 yes | yes | yes | no
7515 Arguments : none
7516
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007517 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007518 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007519 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007520 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7521 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7522 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7523 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7524 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007525 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7526 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7527 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7528 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007529 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007530 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007531 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7532 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7533 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007534
7535 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7536 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7537 been confirmed.
7538
7539 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7540 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007541 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7542 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007543 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7544
7545 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7546 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7547
7548 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7549 stats socket.
7550
7551
7552option accept-invalid-http-response
7553no option accept-invalid-http-response
7554 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7556 yes | no | yes | yes
7557 Arguments : none
7558
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007559 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007560 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007561 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007562 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7563 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7564 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7565 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7566 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007567 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7568 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7569 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007570
7571 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7572 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7573 been confirmed.
7574
7575 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7576 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7577 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7578 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7579
7580 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7581 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7582
7583 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7584 stats socket.
7585
7586
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007587option allbackups
7588no option allbackups
7589 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7591 yes | no | yes | yes
7592 Arguments : none
7593
7594 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7595 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7596 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7597 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7598 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7599 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7600 order between the backup servers anymore.
7601
7602 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7603 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7604
7605 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7606 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7607
7608
7609option checkcache
7610no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007611 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7613 yes | no | yes | yes
7614 Arguments : none
7615
7616 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7617 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007618 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007619 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7620 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007621 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007622
7623 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007624 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007625 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007626 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7627 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007628 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007629 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007630 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7631 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007632 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007633 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7634 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007635 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007636 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7637 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7638 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7639 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7640 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7641 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7642 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7643 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7644 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7645
7646 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007647 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7648 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7649 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7650 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007651
7652 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7653 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007654 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007655 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007656
7657 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7658 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7659
7660
7661option clitcpka
7662no option clitcpka
7663 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7665 yes | yes | yes | no
7666 Arguments : none
7667
7668 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7669 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007670 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007671 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7672
7673 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7674 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7675 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7676 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7677
7678 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7679 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7680 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7681 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7682 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7683
7684 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7685
7686 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7687 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7688 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7689
7690 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7691 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7692
7693 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7694
7695
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007696option contstats
7697 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7699 yes | yes | yes | no
7700 Arguments : none
7701
7702 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7703 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7704 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7705 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007706 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7707 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7708 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7709 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7710 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007711
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007712option disable-h2-upgrade
7713no option disable-h2-upgrade
7714 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7715 connection.
7716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7717 yes | yes | yes | no
7718 Arguments : none
7719
7720 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7721 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7722 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7723 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7724 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7725 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7726 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7727 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7728
7729 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7730 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007731
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007732option dontlog-normal
7733no option dontlog-normal
7734 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7736 yes | yes | yes | no
7737 Arguments : none
7738
7739 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7740 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7741 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7742 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7743 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7744 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7745 logged.
7746
7747 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7748 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7749 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007751 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007752 logging.
7753
7754
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007755option dontlognull
7756no option dontlognull
7757 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7759 yes | yes | yes | no
7760 Arguments : none
7761
7762 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7763 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7764 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7765 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7766 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7767 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007768 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7769 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7770 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007771
7772 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007773 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007774 would not be logged.
7775
7776 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7777 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7778
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007779 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007780 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007781
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007782
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007783option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007784 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7786 yes | yes | yes | yes
7787 Arguments :
7788 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7789 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007790 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007791 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007792
7793 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7794 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7795 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7796 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7797 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7798 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7799 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007800 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7801 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7802 possible that the client has already brought one.
7803
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007804 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007805 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007806 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007807 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007808 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007809 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007810
7811 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7812 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7813 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7814 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7815 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7816 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7817 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7818
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007819 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7820 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7821 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7822 are under the control of the end-user.
7823
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007824 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007825 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7826 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007827 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7828 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7829 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007830
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007831 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007832 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7833 frontend www
7834 mode http
7835 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7836
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007837 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7838 backend www
7839 mode http
7840 option forwardfor header X-Client
7841
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007842 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007843 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007844
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007845
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007846option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7847no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7848 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7850 yes | yes | yes | no
7851 Arguments : none
7852
7853 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7854 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7855 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7856 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7857 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7858 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7859 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7860
7861 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7862 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7863 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7864 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7865 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7866 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7867 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7868 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7869 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7870 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7871
7872 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7873
7874 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7875 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7876
7877 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7878 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7879
7880
7881option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7882no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7883 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7885 yes | no | yes | yes
7886 Arguments : none
7887
7888 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7889 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7890 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7891 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7892 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7893 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7894 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7895
7896 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7897 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7898 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7899 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7900 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7901 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7902 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7903 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7904 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7905 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7906
7907 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7908
7909 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7910 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7911
7912 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7913 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7914
7915
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007916option http-buffer-request
7917no option http-buffer-request
7918 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7920 yes | yes | yes | yes
7921 Arguments : none
7922
7923 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7924 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7925 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7926 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7927 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7928 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007929 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7930 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7931 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7932 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007933
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007934 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007935
7936
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007937option http-ignore-probes
7938no option http-ignore-probes
7939 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7941 yes | yes | yes | no
7942 Arguments : none
7943
7944 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7945 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7946 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7947 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7948 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7949 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7950 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7951 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7952 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007953 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7954 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007955 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7956
7957 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7958 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7959 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7960 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7961 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7962 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7963 are often the only way to detect them.
7964
7965 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7966 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7967
7968 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7969
7970
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007971option http-keep-alive
7972no option http-keep-alive
7973 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7975 yes | yes | yes | yes
7976 Arguments : none
7977
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007978 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7979 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007980 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7981 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007982 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7983 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7984 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007985
7986 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7987 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007988 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7989 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7990 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7991 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7992 situations where this option may be useful :
7993
7994 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007995 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007996
7997 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7998 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7999
8000 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8001 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8002 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8003 request.
8004
8005 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8006 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008007 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8008 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8009 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008010
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008011 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8012 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8013 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8014 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8015 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8016 not set.
8017
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008018 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8019 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8020 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008021
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008022 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008023 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008024 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008025
8026
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008027option http-no-delay
8028no option http-no-delay
8029 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8031 yes | yes | yes | yes
8032 Arguments : none
8033
8034 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8035 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8036 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8037 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8038 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8039 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8040 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8041 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8042 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8043 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8044 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8045 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8046 affected.
8047
8048 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8049 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8050 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8051 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8052 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8053 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8054 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8055 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8056 latency environments.
8057
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008058 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8059
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008060
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008061option http-pretend-keepalive
8062no option http-pretend-keepalive
8063 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008065 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008066 Arguments : none
8067
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008068 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008069 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8070 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8071 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8072 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8073 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8074 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8075 consider the response complete.
8076
8077 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8078 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8079 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8080 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008081 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008082 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8083
8084 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8085 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8086 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8087 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8088 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8089 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8090 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8091
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008092 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8093 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8094 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8095 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8096 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8097 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008098
8099 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8100 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8101
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008102 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008103 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008104
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008105
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008106option http-server-close
8107no option http-server-close
8108 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8110 yes | yes | yes | yes
8111 Arguments : none
8112
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008113 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8114 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8115 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8116 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008117 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8118 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8119 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8120 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8121 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8122 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8123 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8124 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8125 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8126 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8127 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008128
8129 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8130 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8131 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8132 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008133 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8134 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008135
8136 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8137 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008138 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8139 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8140 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008141
8142 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8143 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8144
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008145 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8146 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008147
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008148option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008149no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008150 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8152 yes | yes | yes | no
8153 Arguments : none
8154
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008155 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008156 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8157 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8158 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8159 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8160 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8161 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8162
8163 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8164 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008165 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8166 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8167 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008168
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008169 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8170 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8171 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8172 front of an existing proxy.
8173
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008174 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8175
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008176 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008177
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008178option httpchk
8179option httpchk <uri>
8180option httpchk <method> <uri>
8181option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008182 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8184 yes | no | yes | yes
8185 Arguments :
8186 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8187 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8188 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8189 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8190 ones.
8191
8192 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8193 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8194 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8195
8196 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8197 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8198 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008199 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008200
8201 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8202 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8203 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8204 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8205 the lack of any response.
8206
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008207 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8208 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8209 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8210 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8211
8212 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8213 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8214 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008215
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008216 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8217 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008218 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008219 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008220 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008221
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008222 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8223 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8224 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8225 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8226
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008227 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008228 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8229 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8230 backend https_relay
8231 mode tcp
8232 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8233 http-check send hdr Host www
8234 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008235
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008236 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8237 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8238 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008239
8240
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008241option httpclose
8242no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008243 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8245 yes | yes | yes | yes
8246 Arguments : none
8247
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008248 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8249 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8250 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8251 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008252 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008253
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008254 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8255 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008256 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008257 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8258 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008259
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008260 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8261 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8262 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008263
8264 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8265 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008266 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8267 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8268 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008269
8270 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8271 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8272
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008273 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008274
8275
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008276option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008277 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008279 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008280 Arguments :
8281 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8282 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8283 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008284 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008285 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008286
8287 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8288 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8289 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8290 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8291 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8292 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8293 ports.
8294
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008295 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8296 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008297
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008298 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8299
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008300 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008301
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008302
8303option http_proxy
8304no option http_proxy
8305 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8307 yes | yes | yes | yes
8308 Arguments : none
8309
8310 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8311 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8312 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8313 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8314 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8315
8316 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8317 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008318 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8319 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008320
8321 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8322 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8323
8324 Example :
8325 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8326 backend direct_forward
8327 option httpclose
8328 option http_proxy
8329
8330 See also : "option httpclose"
8331
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008332
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008333option independent-streams
8334no option independent-streams
8335 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8337 yes | yes | yes | yes
8338 Arguments : none
8339
8340 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8341 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8342 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8343 receive data or not.
8344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008345 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008346 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8347 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8348 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8349 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8350 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8351 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8352 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8353 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8354 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8355 socket buffers.
8356
8357 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8358 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8359 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8360 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8361 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8362
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008363 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008364
8365
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008366option ldap-check
8367 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8369 yes | no | yes | yes
8370 Arguments : none
8371
8372 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8373 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8374 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8375 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8376
8377 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8378 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8379
8380 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8381 configure it.
8382
8383 Example :
8384 option ldap-check
8385
8386 See also : "option httpchk"
8387
8388
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008389option external-check
8390 Use external processes for server health checks
8391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8392 yes | no | yes | yes
8393
8394 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8395 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8396 command".
8397
8398 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8399
8400 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8401
8402
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008403option log-health-checks
8404no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008405 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8407 yes | no | yes | yes
8408 Arguments : none
8409
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008410 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8411 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8412 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008413
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008414 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8415 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8416 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8417 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8418 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8419
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008420 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008421 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008422
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008423 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8424 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8425 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008426
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008427
8428option log-separate-errors
8429no option log-separate-errors
8430 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8432 yes | yes | yes | no
8433 Arguments : none
8434
8435 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8436 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8437 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8438 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8439 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8440 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8441 provides very important information.
8442
8443 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8444 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8445 error logs.
8446
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008447 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008448 logging.
8449
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008450
8451option logasap
8452no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008453 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8455 yes | yes | yes | no
8456 Arguments : none
8457
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008458 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8459 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8460 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8461 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8462
8463 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8464 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8465 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8466 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8467 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008468 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008469 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8470 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8471 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8472 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008473 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008474
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008475 Examples :
8476 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8477 mode http
8478 option httplog
8479 option logasap
8480 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8481
8482 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8483 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8484 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8485 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008487 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008488 logging.
8489
8490
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008491option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008492 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8494 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008495 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008496 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8497 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008498 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8499 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008500
8501 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8502 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008503 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008504 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8505 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8506 in the MySQL table, like this :
8507
8508 USE mysql;
8509 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8510 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8511
8512 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008513 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008514 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8515 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8516 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8517 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8518 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8519 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8520 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8521
8522 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8523 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008524
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008525 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008526
8527 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8528 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8529 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8530 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008531 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8532 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008533
8534 See also: "option httpchk"
8535
8536
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008537option nolinger
8538no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008539 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008540 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8541 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008542 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008543
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008544 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008545 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8546 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8547 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8548 connections.
8549
8550 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8551 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008552 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8553 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8554 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8555 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8556 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8557 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8558 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8559 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8560 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8561 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8562 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8563 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8564 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008565
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008566 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8567 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8568 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8569 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8570 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008571
8572 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8573 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008574 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
8575 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidently
8576 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008577
8578 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8579 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8580
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008581 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8582 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008583
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008584option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8585 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8587 yes | yes | yes | yes
8588 Arguments :
8589 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8590 matching <network>
8591 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8592 header name.
8593
8594 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8595 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8596 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8597 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8598 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8599 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8600 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8601 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8602 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8603 possible that the client has already brought one.
8604
8605 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8606 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8607 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8608 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8609 header and requires different one.
8610
8611 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8612 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8613 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8614 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8615 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8616 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8617 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8618
8619 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8620 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8621 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8622 both are defined.
8623
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008624 Examples :
8625 # Original Destination address
8626 frontend www
8627 mode http
8628 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8629
8630 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8631 backend www
8632 mode http
8633 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8634
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008635 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008636
8637
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008638option persist
8639no option persist
8640 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8641 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8642 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008643 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008644
8645 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8646 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8647 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8648 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8649 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8650 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8651 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8652 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8653 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8654 redirected to another valid server.
8655
8656 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8657 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8658
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008659 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008660
8661
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008662option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8663 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8665 yes | no | yes | yes
8666 Arguments :
8667 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8668 PostgreSQL server.
8669
8670 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8671 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8672 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8673 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8674
8675 See also: "option httpchk"
8676
8677
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008678option prefer-last-server
8679no option prefer-last-server
8680 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8681 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8682 yes | no | yes | yes
8683 Arguments : none
8684
8685 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8686 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8687 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8688 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8689 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8690 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8691 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8692 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8693 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008694 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8695 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008696 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8697 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8698 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008699 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8700 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8701 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008702
8703 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8704 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8705
8706 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8707
8708
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008709option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008710option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008711no option redispatch
8712 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8713 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8714 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008715 Arguments :
8716 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8717 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8718 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008719 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008720 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008721 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008722 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8723 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8724 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8725
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008726
8727 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8728 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8729 be able to access the service anymore.
8730
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008731 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8732 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008733
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008734 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8735 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8736 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8737 following order:
8738
8739 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8740
8741 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8742 list, or
8743
8744 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8745
8746 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8747 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8748
8749 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8750 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8751 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8752 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8753
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008754 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008755 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8756 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008757
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008758 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8759 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8760
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008761 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008762
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008763
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008764option redis-check
8765 Use redis health checks for server testing
8766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8767 yes | no | yes | yes
8768 Arguments : none
8769
8770 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8771 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8772 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8773 find the "+PONG" response message.
8774
8775 Example :
8776 option redis-check
8777
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008778 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008779
8780
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008781option smtpchk
8782option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8783 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8785 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008786 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008787 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008788 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008789 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8790
8791 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8792 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8793 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8794
8795 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8796 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8797 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8798 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8799 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8800 dead server.
8801
8802 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8803 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008804 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008805 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8806
8807 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8808 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8809 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8810 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008811 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008812
8813 Example :
8814 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8815
8816 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8817
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008818
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008819option socket-stats
8820no option socket-stats
8821
8822 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8824 yes | yes | yes | no
8825
8826 Arguments : none
8827
8828
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008829option splice-auto
8830no option splice-auto
8831 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8833 yes | yes | yes | yes
8834 Arguments : none
8835
8836 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8837 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008838 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008839 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008840 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008841 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8842 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8843 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8844 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8845
8846 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8847 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8848 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8849 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8850 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8851 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8852 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8853 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8854 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8855 keyword.
8856
8857 Example :
8858 option splice-auto
8859
8860 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8861 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8862
8863 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8864 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8865
8866
8867option splice-request
8868no option splice-request
8869 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8871 yes | yes | yes | yes
8872 Arguments : none
8873
8874 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008875 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008876 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8877 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8878 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8879 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8880
8881 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8882
8883 Example :
8884 option splice-request
8885
8886 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8887 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8888
8889 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8890 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8891
8892
8893option splice-response
8894no option splice-response
8895 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8897 yes | yes | yes | yes
8898 Arguments : none
8899
8900 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008901 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008902 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8903 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8904 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8905 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8906
8907 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8908
8909 Example :
8910 option splice-response
8911
8912 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8913 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8914
8915 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8916 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8917
8918
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008919option spop-check
8920 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8922 no | no | no | yes
8923 Arguments : none
8924
8925 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8926 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8927 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8928 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8929
8930 Example :
8931 option spop-check
8932
8933 See also : "option httpchk"
8934
8935
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008936option srvtcpka
8937no option srvtcpka
8938 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8940 yes | no | yes | yes
8941 Arguments : none
8942
8943 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8944 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008945 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008946 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8947
8948 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8949 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8950 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8951 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8952
8953 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8954 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8955 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8956 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8957 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8958
8959 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8960
8961 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8962 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8963 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8964
8965 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8966 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8967
8968 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8969
8970
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008971option ssl-hello-chk
8972 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8974 yes | no | yes | yes
8975 Arguments : none
8976
8977 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8978 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8979 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8980 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8981 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8982 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8983 hello message.
8984
8985 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8986 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8987 messages, which is appreciable.
8988
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008989 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8990 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8991 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008992
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008993 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8994
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008995
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008996option tcp-check
8997 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8998 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8999 yes | no | yes | yes
9000
9001 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9002 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9003
9004 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9005 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9006 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9007
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009008 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009009 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9010 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9011 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9012 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9013 only.
9014
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009015 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009016 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9017 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9018 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9019 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9020
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009021 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009022 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9023 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009024 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009025 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9026 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9027 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9028 the respective protocols.
9029 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009030 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009031
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009032 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009033
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009034 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9035 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9036 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9037 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009038
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009039 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9040 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9041 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009042
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009043
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009044 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009045 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009046 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009047 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009048
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009049 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009050 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009051 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009052
9053 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9054 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009055 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009056 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009057 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009058 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009059 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009060 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009061 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9062 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009063 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009064 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9065 tcp-check expect string +OK
9066
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009067 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009068 (send many headers before analyzing)
9069 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009070 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009071 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9072 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9073 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9074 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009075 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009076
9077
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009078 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009079
9080
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009081option tcp-smart-accept
9082no option tcp-smart-accept
9083 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9085 yes | yes | yes | no
9086 Arguments : none
9087
9088 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9089 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9090 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9091 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9092 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9093 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9094
9095 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9096 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9097 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9098 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9099
9100 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9101 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9102 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009103 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009104
9105 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9106 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9107 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9108
9109 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9110 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9111 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9112
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009113 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9114
9115
9116option tcp-smart-connect
9117no option tcp-smart-connect
9118 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9120 yes | no | yes | yes
9121 Arguments : none
9122
9123 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9124 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9125 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9126 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9127 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9128
9129 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9130 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9131 complex.
9132
9133 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9134 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9135 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9136
9137 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9138 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9139
9140 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9141
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009142
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009143option tcpka
9144 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9146 yes | yes | yes | yes
9147 Arguments : none
9148
9149 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9150 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009151 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009152 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9153
9154 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9155 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9156 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9157 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9158
9159 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9160 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9161 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9162 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9163 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9164
9165 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9166
9167 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9168 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9169 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9170 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9171 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9172 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9173 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9174 backends.
9175
9176 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9177
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009178
9179option tcplog
9180 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009182 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009183 Arguments : none
9184
9185 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9186 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9187 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9188 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9189 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9190 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9191 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9192 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9193
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009194 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9195
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009196 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009197
9198
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009199option transparent
9200no option transparent
9201 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009203 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009204 Arguments : none
9205
9206 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9207 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9208 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9209 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9210 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9211 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9212 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9213 appropriate server.
9214
9215 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9216 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9217
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009218 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009219 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009220
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009221
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009222external-check command <command>
9223 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9225 yes | no | yes | yes
9226
9227 Arguments :
9228 <command> is the external command to run
9229
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009230 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9231
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009232 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009233
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009234 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9235 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9236 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9237 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9238 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9239 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009240
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009241 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9242
9243 Environment variables :
9244 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9245 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9246
9247 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9248
9249 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9250
9251 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9252 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9253 for a UNIX socket).
9254
9255 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9256
9257 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9258
9259 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9260
9261 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9262
9263 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9264
9265 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9266 socket).
9267
9268 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9269 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9270
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009271 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9272
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009273 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9274 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9275 failed.
9276
9277 Example :
9278 external-check command /bin/true
9279
9280 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9281
9282
9283external-check path <path>
9284 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9286 yes | no | yes | yes
9287
9288 Arguments :
9289 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9290
9291 The default path is "".
9292
9293 Example :
9294 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9295
9296 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9297 "external-check command"
9298
9299
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009300persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009301persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009302 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9304 yes | no | yes | yes
9305 Arguments :
9306 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009307 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9308 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009309
9310 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9311 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009312 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009313 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9314 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9315 forwarded to this server.
9316
9317 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9318 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9319 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009320 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009321 a single "listen" section.
9322
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009323 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9324 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9325 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9326
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009327 Example :
9328 listen tse-farm
9329 bind :3389
9330 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9331 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9332 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9333 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9334 persist rdp-cookie
9335 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009336 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009337 balance rdp-cookie
9338 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9339 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9340
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009341 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9342 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009343
9344
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009345rate-limit sessions <rate>
9346 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9348 yes | yes | yes | no
9349 Arguments :
9350 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9351 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9352
9353 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9354 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9355 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9356 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9357 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9358 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9359
9360 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9361 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9362 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9363 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9364
9365 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9366 listen smtp
9367 mode tcp
9368 bind :25
9369 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009370 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009371
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009372 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9373 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9374 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009375
9376 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9377
9378
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009379redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9380redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9381redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009382 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9384 no | yes | yes | yes
9385
9386 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009387 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009388
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009389 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009390 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009391 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9392 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9393 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009394
9395 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9396 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9397 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9398 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9399 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009400 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9401 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9402 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9403 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009404
9405 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9406 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9407 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9408 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9409 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9410 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009411 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009412 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009413 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9414 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9415 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009416
9417 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009418 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9419 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9420 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009421 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009422 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9423 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9424 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9425 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009426
9427 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009428 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009429
9430 - "drop-query"
9431 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9432 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9433 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9434 with a location-type redirect.
9435
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009436 - "append-slash"
9437 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9438 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9439 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9440 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9441
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009442 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9443 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9444 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9445 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9446 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9447 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9448 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9449
9450 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9451 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9452 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9453 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9454 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9455 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9456 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009457
9458 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9459 acl clear dst_port 80
9460 acl secure dst_port 8080
9461 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009462 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009463 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009464 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9465
9466 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009467 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9468 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9469 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009470 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009471
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009472 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9473 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9474 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9475
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009476 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009477 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009478
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009479 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009480 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9481 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9482 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009483
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009484 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009485
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009486
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009487retries <value>
9488 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9489 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9490 yes | no | yes | yes
9491 Arguments :
9492 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9493 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9494 default value is 3.
9495
9496 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9497 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9498 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9499
9500 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009501 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9502 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009503
9504 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9505 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9506
9507 See also : "option redispatch"
9508
9509
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009510retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009511 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9512 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9513 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009514 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9515 yes | no | yes | yes
9516 Arguments :
9517 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9518 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9519 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9520 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9521
9522 none never retry
9523
9524 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9525 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9526
9527 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9528 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9529 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9530 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9531 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9532 processing the request.
9533
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009534 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9535 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9536 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9537 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9538 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9539 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9540 overflow attack for example).
9541
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009542 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9543 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9544 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9545 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9546 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9547 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9548 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9549 amplify denial of service attacks.
9550
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009551 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9552 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9553 considered to be safe to retry.
9554
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +01009555 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
9556 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
9557 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
9558 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
9559 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009560
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009561 all-retryable-errors
9562 retry request for any error that are considered
9563 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9564 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9565 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9566
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009567 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9568 not cumulative.
9569
9570 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9571 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9572 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9573 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9574
9575 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9576 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9577 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9578 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9579 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9580 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9581 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9582 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9583 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9584 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9585 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9586 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9587
9588 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9589 should not use this directive.
9590
9591 The default is "conn-failure".
9592
9593 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9594
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009595server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009596 Declare a server in a backend
9597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9598 no | no | yes | yes
9599 Arguments :
9600 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009601 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009602 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009603
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009604 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9605 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9606 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9607 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009608 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9609 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9610 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9611 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9612 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009613 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9614 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9615 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9616 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9617 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9618 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9619 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009620 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009621 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9622 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9623 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9624 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9625 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9626 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009627 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9628 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009629 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9630 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009631
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009632 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009633 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9634 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9635 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9636 adding this value to the client's port.
9637
9638 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9639 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009640 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009641
9642 Examples :
9643 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9644 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009645 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009646 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9647 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9648 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009649
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009650 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9651 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9652 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9653 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9654 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9655
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009656 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9657 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009658
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009659server-state-file-name [<file>]
9660 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9661 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9662 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9663 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9664 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9665 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9666
9667 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9668 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9669
9670 global
9671 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9672
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009673 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009674 load-server-state-from-file
9675
9676 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9677 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009678
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009679server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9680 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9681 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9683 no | no | yes | yes
9684
9685 Arguments:
9686 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9687
9688 <num | range>
9689 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9690 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9691 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9692 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9693
9694 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9695
9696 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9697
9698 <params*>
9699 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9700 keyword.
9701
9702 Examples:
9703 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9704 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9705 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9706
9707 # or
9708 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9709
9710 # would be equivalent to:
9711 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9712 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9713 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9714
9715
9716
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009717source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009718source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009719source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009720 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9722 yes | no | yes | yes
9723 Arguments :
9724 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9725 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009726
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009727 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009728 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9729 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9730 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9731 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9732 supported prefixes are :
9733 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9734 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9735 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009736 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009737 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9738 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009739
9740 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9741 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009742 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9743 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9744 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009745
9746 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9747 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9748 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9749 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9750 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9751 <addr>.
9752
9753 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9754 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9755 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9756 port.
9757
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009758 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9759 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9760 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9761 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009762 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009763 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9764 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9765 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9766 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9767 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9768 HTTP header.
9769
9770 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9771 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009772 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009773 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9774 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9775 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9776 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9777 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9778 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9779 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9780
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009781 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9782 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9783 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9784 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9785 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9786 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9787
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009788 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9789 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9790 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9791 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9792
9793 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9794 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9795 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9796 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9797 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9798 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9799
9800 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9801 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9802 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9803 there are two methods :
9804
9805 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9806 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9807 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9808 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9809 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9810 of the client ranges may be used.
9811
9812 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9813 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9814 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9815 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9816 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9817 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9818 same session.
9819
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009820 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9821 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9822 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009823 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009824
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009825 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9826
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009827 Examples :
9828 backend private
9829 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9830 source 192.168.1.200
9831
9832 backend transparent_ssl1
9833 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9834 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9835
9836 backend transparent_ssl2
9837 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9838 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9839 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9840
9841 backend transparent_ssl3
9842 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9843 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9844 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9845
9846 backend transparent_smtp
9847 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9848 # with Tproxy version 4.
9849 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9850
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009851 backend transparent_http
9852 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9853 # proxy.
9854 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9855
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009856 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009857 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9858
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009859
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009860srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9861 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9862 the connection on the server side.
9863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9864 yes | no | yes | yes
9865 Arguments :
9866 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9867
9868 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9869 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009870 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9871 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009872
9873 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9874
9875
9876srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9877 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9878 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9879 server side.
9880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9881 yes | no | yes | yes
9882 Arguments :
9883 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9884 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9885 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9886 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9887
9888 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9889 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009890 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9891 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009892
9893 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9894
9895
9896srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9897 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9899 yes | no | yes | yes
9900 Arguments :
9901 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9902 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9903 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9904 document.
9905
9906 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9907 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009908 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9909 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009910
9911 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9912
9913
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009914stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9915 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009917 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009918
9919 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9920 matched.
9921
9922 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9923 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9924
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009925 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9926 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009927 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009928
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009929 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9930 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9931 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9932 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009933
9934 Example :
9935 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9936 backend stats_localhost
9937 stats enable
9938 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9939
9940 Example :
9941 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9942 backend stats_auth
9943 stats enable
9944 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9945 stats admin if TRUE
9946
9947 Example :
9948 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9949 userlist stats-auth
9950 group admin users admin
9951 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9952 group readonly users haproxy
9953 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9954
9955 backend stats_auth
9956 stats enable
9957 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9958 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9959 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9960 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9961
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009962 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9963 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9964 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009965
9966
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009967stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9968 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009970 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009971 Arguments :
9972 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9973
9974 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9975
9976 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9977 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9978 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9979 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9980 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9981 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9982
9983 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9984 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9985 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009986 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009987
9988 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9989 report using "stats scope".
9990
9991 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9992 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9993 unobvious parameters.
9994
9995 Example :
9996 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9997 backend public_www
9998 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9999 stats enable
10000 stats hide-version
10001 stats scope .
10002 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010003 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010004 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10005 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10006
10007 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10008 backend private_monitoring
10009 stats enable
10010 stats uri /admin?stats
10011 stats refresh 5s
10012
10013 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10014
10015
10016stats enable
10017 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010019 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010020 Arguments : none
10021
10022 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10023 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10024 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10025 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10026 - stats auth : no authentication
10027 - stats scope : no restriction
10028
10029 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10030 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10031 unobvious parameters.
10032
10033 Example :
10034 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10035 backend public_www
10036 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10037 stats enable
10038 stats hide-version
10039 stats scope .
10040 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010041 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010042 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10043 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10044
10045 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10046 backend private_monitoring
10047 stats enable
10048 stats uri /admin?stats
10049 stats refresh 5s
10050
10051 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10052
10053
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010054stats hide-version
10055 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010057 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010058 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010059
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010060 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10061 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10062 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10063 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10064 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10065 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010066
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010067 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10068 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10069 unobvious parameters.
10070
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010071 Example :
10072 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10073 backend public_www
10074 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010075 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010076 stats hide-version
10077 stats scope .
10078 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010079 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010080 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10081 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010082
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010083 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10084 backend private_monitoring
10085 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010086 stats uri /admin?stats
10087 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010088
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010089 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010090
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010091
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010092stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10093 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10094 Access control for statistics
10095
10096 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10097 no | no | yes | yes
10098
10099 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10100 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10101 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10102 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10103 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10104 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10105
10106 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10107 instance.
10108
10109 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10110 about ACL usage.
10111
10112
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010113stats realm <realm>
10114 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010116 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010117 Arguments :
10118 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10119 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10120 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10121
10122 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10123 using a backslash ('\').
10124
10125 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10126 only related to authentication.
10127
10128 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10129 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10130 unobvious parameters.
10131
10132 Example :
10133 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10134 backend public_www
10135 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10136 stats enable
10137 stats hide-version
10138 stats scope .
10139 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010140 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010141 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10142 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10143
10144 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10145 backend private_monitoring
10146 stats enable
10147 stats uri /admin?stats
10148 stats refresh 5s
10149
10150 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10151
10152
10153stats refresh <delay>
10154 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010156 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010157 Arguments :
10158 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10159 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10160 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10161 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10162 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10163 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10164
10165 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10166 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10167 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010168 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010169
10170 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10171 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10172 unobvious parameters.
10173
10174 Example :
10175 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10176 backend public_www
10177 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10178 stats enable
10179 stats hide-version
10180 stats scope .
10181 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010182 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010183 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10184 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10185
10186 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10187 backend private_monitoring
10188 stats enable
10189 stats uri /admin?stats
10190 stats refresh 5s
10191
10192 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10193
10194
10195stats scope { <name> | "." }
10196 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010198 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010199 Arguments :
10200 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10201 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10202 section in which the statement appears.
10203
10204 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10205 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10206 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10207 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10208 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10209 exists.
10210
10211 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10212 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10213 unobvious parameters.
10214
10215 Example :
10216 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10217 backend public_www
10218 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10219 stats enable
10220 stats hide-version
10221 stats scope .
10222 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010223 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010224 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10225 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10226
10227 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10228 backend private_monitoring
10229 stats enable
10230 stats uri /admin?stats
10231 stats refresh 5s
10232
10233 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10234
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010235
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010236stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010237 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010239 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010240
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010241 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010242 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10243
10244 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10245 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10246
10247 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10248 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010249 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010250
10251 Example :
10252 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10253 backend private_monitoring
10254 stats enable
10255 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10256 stats uri /admin?stats
10257 stats refresh 5s
10258
10259 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10260 global section.
10261
10262
10263stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010264 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10266 yes | yes | yes | yes
10267 Arguments : none
10268
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010269 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010270 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10271 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10272 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10273 - IP (socket, server)
10274 - cookie (backend, server)
10275
10276 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10277 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010278 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010279
10280 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10281
10282
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010283stats show-modules
10284 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10286 yes | yes | yes | yes
10287 Arguments : none
10288
10289 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10290 values as a tooltip.
10291
10292 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10293 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10294 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10295
10296 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10297
10298
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010299stats show-node [ <name> ]
10300 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010302 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010303 Arguments:
10304 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10305 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10306
10307 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10308 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010309 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010310
10311 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10312 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10313 unobvious parameters.
10314
10315 Example:
10316 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10317 backend private_monitoring
10318 stats enable
10319 stats show-node Europe-1
10320 stats uri /admin?stats
10321 stats refresh 5s
10322
10323 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10324 section.
10325
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010326
10327stats uri <prefix>
10328 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010330 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010331 Arguments :
10332 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10333 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10334 query string.
10335
10336 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10337 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10338 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10339 possible to reach it in the application.
10340
10341 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010342 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010343 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10344 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10345 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10346 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10347
10348 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10349 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10350 an address or a port to statistics only.
10351
10352 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10353 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10354 unobvious parameters.
10355
10356 Example :
10357 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10358 backend public_www
10359 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10360 stats enable
10361 stats hide-version
10362 stats scope .
10363 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010364 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010365 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10366 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10367
10368 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10369 backend private_monitoring
10370 stats enable
10371 stats uri /admin?stats
10372 stats refresh 5s
10373
10374 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10375
10376
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010377stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10378 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010380 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010381
10382 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010383 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010384 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010385 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010386 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10387
10388 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10389 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10390 the "stick-table" statement.
10391
10392 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10393 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10394 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10395 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10396 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10397
10398 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10399 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10400 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10401 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10402 transformation rules.
10403
10404 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10405 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10406 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10407 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10408 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10409 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10410 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10411
10412 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10413 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10414 ACL based conditions.
10415
10416 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10417 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10418 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10419 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10420
10421 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10422 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10423 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10424 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10425
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010426 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10427 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010428 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010429
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010430 Example :
10431 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10432 # last 30 minutes
10433 backend pop
10434 mode tcp
10435 balance roundrobin
10436 stick store-request src
10437 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10438 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10439 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10440
10441 backend smtp
10442 mode tcp
10443 balance roundrobin
10444 stick match src table pop
10445 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10446 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10447
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010448 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010449 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010450
10451
10452stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10453 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10455 no | no | yes | yes
10456
10457 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10458 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10459 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10460 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10461
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010462 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10463 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010464 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010465
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010466 Examples :
10467 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010468 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010469
10470 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10471 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10472 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10473
10474
10475 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10476 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10477 backend http
10478 mode http
10479 balance roundrobin
10480 stick on src table https
10481 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10482 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10483 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10484
10485 backend https
10486 mode tcp
10487 balance roundrobin
10488 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10489 stick on src
10490 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10491 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10492
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010493 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010494
10495
10496stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10497 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10499 no | no | yes | yes
10500
10501 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010502 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010503 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010504 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010505 server is selected.
10506
10507 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10508 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10509 the "stick-table" statement.
10510
10511 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10512 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10513 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10514 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10515 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10516 address.
10517
10518 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10519 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10520 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10521 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10522 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10523 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10524 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10525 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10526 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10527 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10528
10529 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10530 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10531 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10532 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10533 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10534 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10535 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10536
10537 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10538 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10539 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10540 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10541
10542 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10543 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10544 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10545 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10546 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10547 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010548 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10549 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10550 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10551 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10552 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10553 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010554
10555 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10556 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10557 the request.
10558
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010559 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10560 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010561 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010562
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010563 Example :
10564 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10565 # last 30 minutes
10566 backend pop
10567 mode tcp
10568 balance roundrobin
10569 stick store-request src
10570 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10571 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10572 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10573
10574 backend smtp
10575 mode tcp
10576 balance roundrobin
10577 stick match src table pop
10578 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10579 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10580
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010581 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010582 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010583
10584
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010585stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010586 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10587 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010588 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010590 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010591
10592 Arguments :
10593 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10594 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10595 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10596 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10597
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010598 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10599 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10600 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10601 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10602
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010603 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10604 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10605 instance.
10606
10607 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10608 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10609 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10610 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10611 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10612 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010613 to 32 characters.
10614
10615 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10616 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10617 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010618 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010619 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10620 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010621
10622 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010623 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10624 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010625 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10626 increase.
10627
10628 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010629 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10630 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10631 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010632
10633 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10634 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10635 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10636 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010637 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010638 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10639 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10640 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10641 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10642 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10643 parameter (see below).
10644
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010645 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10646 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10647 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10648 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10649 soft restart.
10650
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010651 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10652 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010653
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010654 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10655 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10656 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10657 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010658 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010659 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010660 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10661 if not expiration delay is specified.
10662
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010663 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10664 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10665 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10666 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010667 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10668 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10669 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10670 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10671 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10672 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10673 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10674 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10675 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10676 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10677 types and their arguments.
10678
10679 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10680 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10681 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10682 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10683
10684 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10685 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10686 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010687 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010688
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010689 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10690 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10691 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010692 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010693 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010694 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010695
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010696 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10697 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10698 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10699 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10700
10701 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10702 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10703 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10704 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10705 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10706 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10707
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010708 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10709 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10710 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10711 they were received.
10712
10713 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10714 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10715 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10716 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10717 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10718
10719 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10720 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10721 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10722 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10723 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10724
10725 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10726 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10727 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10728
10729 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10730 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10731 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10732 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10733 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10734
10735 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10736 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10737 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10738 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10739 the client side.
10740
10741 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10742 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10743 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10744 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10745 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10746 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10747 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10748
10749 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10750 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10751 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10752 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10753 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10754 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010755 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010756
10757 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10758 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10759 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10760 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10761 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10762 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10763
10764 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010765 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010766 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10767 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10768
10769 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10770 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10771 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10772 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10773 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10774 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10775 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10776 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10777 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10778 recommended for better fairness.
10779
10780 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010781 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010782 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10783 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10784
10785 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10786 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10787 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10788 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10789 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10790 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10791 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10792 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10793 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10794 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010795
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010796 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10797 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010798 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10799 reference it.
10800
10801 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10802 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010803 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10804 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10805 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010806
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010807 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10808 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10809 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10810 something that can be ignored.
10811
10812 Example:
10813 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10814 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10815 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10816 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10817
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010818 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010819 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010820
10821
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010822stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010823 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10825 no | no | yes | yes
10826
10827 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010828 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010829 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010830 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010831 server is selected.
10832
10833 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10834 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10835 the "stick-table" statement.
10836
10837 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10838 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10839 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10840 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10841
10842 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10843 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10844 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10845 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10846 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10847 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010848 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010849 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10850 rules.
10851
10852 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10853 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10854 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10855 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10856 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10857 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10858 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10859
10860 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10861 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10862 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10863 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10864
10865 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10866 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10867 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10868 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10869 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10870 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010871 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10872 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10873 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10874 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10875 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10876 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10877 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10878 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10879 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010880
10881 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10882
10883 Example :
10884 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10885 backend https
10886 mode tcp
10887 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010888 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010889 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010890
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010891 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10892 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10893
10894 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10895 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10896 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10897
10898 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10899 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010900
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010901 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10902 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10903 # at offset 44.
10904
10905 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10906 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10907
10908 # Learn on response if server hello.
10909 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010910
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010911 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10912 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10913
10914 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10915 extraction.
10916
10917
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010918tcp-check comment <string>
10919 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10920 it fails.
10921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10922 yes | no | yes | yes
10923
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010924 Arguments :
10925 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10926 rule fails.
10927
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010928 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10929 user-friendly error reporting.
10930
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010931 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10932 "tcp-check expect".
10933
10934
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010935tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10936 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010937 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010938 Opens a new connection
10939 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010940 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010941
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010942 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010943 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10944
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010945 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010946 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010947
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010948 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010949 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10950 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010951 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010952
10953 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010954
10955 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10956
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010957 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10958
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010959 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10960
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010961 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10962
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010963 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10964 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10965 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10966 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10967
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010968 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10969 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10970 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10971 haproxy -vv.
10972
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010973 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010974
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010975 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10976 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10977 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10978
10979 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10980 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10981 of the sequence.
10982
10983 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10984 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10985 do.
10986
10987 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10988 unset-var or comment rules.
10989
10990 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010991 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10992 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10993 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10994 option tcp-check
10995 tcp-check connect
10996 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10997 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10998 tcp-check send \r\n
10999 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11000 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11001 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11002 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11003 tcp-check send \r\n
11004 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11005 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11006
11007 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11008 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011009 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011010 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11011 tcp-check connect port 143
11012 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11013 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11014
11015 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11016
11017
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011018tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011019 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011020 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011021 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011022 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011023 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011024 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011025
11026 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011027 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11028
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011029 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11030 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11031 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11032 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11033 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11034 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11035 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11036 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11037 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11038 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11039
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011040 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011041 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11042 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011043 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11044 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11045 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11046
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011047 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11048 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11049 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011050 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11051 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011052 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11053 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011054 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11055 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011056 By default "L7OK" is used.
11057
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011058 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11059 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011060 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11061 supported :
11062 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11063 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011064 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11065 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11066 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11067 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11068 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011069
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011070 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011071 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011072 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11073 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11074 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11075 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011076 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11077
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011078 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11079 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11080 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11081 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11082
11083 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11084 informational message reported in logs if an error
11085 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11086 log-format string.
11087
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011088 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11089 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11090 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11091 followed by some converters.
11092
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011093 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11094 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11095 with the usual backslash ('\').
11096 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011097 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011098 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11099 used upper or lower case.
11100
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011101 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11102
11103 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11104 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11105 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11106 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11107 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11108 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11109 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11110 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11111
11112 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11113 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11114 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11115 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11116 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11117 expression.
11118
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011119 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11120 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11121 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11122 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11123 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11124 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11125
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011126 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11127 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11128 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11129 this exact hexadecimal string.
11130 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11131
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011132 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11133 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11134 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11135 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11136 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11137 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11138 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11139 size.
11140
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011141 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11142 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11143 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11144 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11145 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11146 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11147 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11148 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11149 in a binary string before matching the response's
11150 buffer.
11151
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011152 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011153 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011154 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11155 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11156 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11157 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11158 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11159 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11160 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11161 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11162 the null character.
11163
11164 Examples :
11165 # perform a POP check
11166 option tcp-check
11167 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11168
11169 # perform an IMAP check
11170 option tcp-check
11171 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11172
11173 # look for the redis master server
11174 option tcp-check
11175 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011176 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011177 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11178 tcp-check expect string role:master
11179 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11180 tcp-check expect string +OK
11181
11182
11183 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011184 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011185
11186
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011187tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11188tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11189 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11190 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011191 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011192 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011193
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011194 Arguments :
11195 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11196
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011197 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11198 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011199
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011200 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11201 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011202
11203 Examples :
11204 # look for the redis master server
11205 option tcp-check
11206 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11207 tcp-check expect string role:master
11208
11209 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011210 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011211
11212
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011213tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11214tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11215 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11216 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011217 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011218 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011219
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011220 Arguments :
11221 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011222
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011223 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11224 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011225
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011226 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11227 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11228 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011229
11230 Examples :
11231 # redis check in binary
11232 option tcp-check
11233 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11234 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11235
11236
11237 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011238 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011239
11240
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011241tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011242 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011243 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011244 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011245
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011246 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011247 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11248 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11249 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11250 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11251 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11252 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11253 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11254 and '-'.
11255
11256 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11257
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011258 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011259 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11260
11261
11262tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011263 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011264 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011265 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011266
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011267 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011268 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11269 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11270 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11271 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11272 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11273 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11274 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11275 and '-'.
11276
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011277 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011278 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11279
11280
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011281tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11282 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11284 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011285 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011286 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11287 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011288
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011289 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011290
11291 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11292 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011293 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11294 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11295 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11296 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11297 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11298 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011299
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011300 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11301 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11302 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11303 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011304
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011305 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011306 - accept :
11307 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11308 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11309 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011310
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011311 - reject :
11312 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11313 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11314 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11315 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11316 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11317 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11318 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11319 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11320 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11321 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11322 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011323 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011324
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011325 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11326 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11327 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11328 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11329 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11330 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11331 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11332 hosts.
11333
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011334 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11335 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11336 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11337 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11338 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11339 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11340 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11341 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11342
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011343 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11344 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11345 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11346 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11347 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11348 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11349 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11350 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11351 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011352 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11353 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011354
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011355 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011356 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011357 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11358 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11359 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011360 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011361 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011362 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11363 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11364 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11365 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11366 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11367 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11368 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011369
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011370 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011371 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011372 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011373 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011374 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11375 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11376 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011377
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011378 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11379 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11380 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11381 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011382
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011383 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11384 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11385 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11386 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11387 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011388 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11389 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11390 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11391 layer7 information is extracted.
11392
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011393 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11394 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11395 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11396 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11397 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011398
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011399 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11400 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11401 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11402 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11403
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011404 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11405 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11406 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11407 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11408
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011409 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11410 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11411 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11412 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11413 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011414
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011415 - set-src <expr> :
11416 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11417 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11418 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011419 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011420
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011421 Arguments:
11422 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11423 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011424
11425 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011426 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11427
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011428 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11429 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011430
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011431 - set-src-port <expr> :
11432 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11433 expression.
11434
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011435 Arguments:
11436 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11437 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011438
11439 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011440 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11441
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011442 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11443 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11444 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011445
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011446 - set-dst <expr> :
11447 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11448 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11449 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11450 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11451 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11452
11453 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11454 followed by some converters.
11455
11456 Example:
11457
11458 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11459 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11460
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011461 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11462 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11463
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011464 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11465 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11466 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11467 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11468
11469
11470 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11471 followed by some converters.
11472
11473 Example:
11474
11475 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11476
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011477 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11478 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11479 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11480
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011481 - "silent-drop" :
11482 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011483 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011484 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11485 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11486 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11487 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11488 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011489 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11490 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011491 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11492 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011493 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011494 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11495 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11496 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11497 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11498
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011499 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11500 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11501 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011502
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011503 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11504 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11505 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011506
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011507 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011508 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011509 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011510
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011511 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11512 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11513 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011514
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011515 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011516 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11517 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011518
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011519 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11520
11521 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11522
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011523 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11524
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011525 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011526
11527
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011528tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11529 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011531 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011532 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011533 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11534 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011535
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011536 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011537
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011538 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011539 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11540 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11541 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11542 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011543
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011544 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11545 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11546 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11547 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011548 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11549 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11550 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11551 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11552 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11553 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011554 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011555 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011556
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011557 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11558 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11559 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11560 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011561
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011562 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011563 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011564 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011565 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11566 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011567 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011568 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011569 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011570 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011571 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011572 - set-dst <expr>
11573 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011574 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011575 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011576 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011577 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011578 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011579
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011580 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11581 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011582 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11583 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011584
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011585 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11586 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11587 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11588 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11589 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11590 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011591
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011592 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011593 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11594 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011595
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011596 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11597 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11598 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11599 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11600 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11601 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11602
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011603 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011604 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11605 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11606 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11607 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11608 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11609 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11610 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11611 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11612 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11613 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011614
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011615 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011616 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11617 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11618 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011619
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011620 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11621 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11622
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011623 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011624 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11625 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011626
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011627 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11628 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011629 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011630 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11631 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011632 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011633 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011634 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011635 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11636 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011637 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011638 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11639 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011640
11641 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11642 followed by some converters.
11643
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011644 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11645 <var-name>.
11646
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011647 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11648 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11649 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11650 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11651 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11652
11653 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11654 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11655 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11656 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11657 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11658 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11659 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11660 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11661 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11662 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11663 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11664
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011665 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11666 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11667 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11668 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11669 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11670
11671 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11672
11673 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11674
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011675 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11676 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11677 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11678 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11679 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11680 evaluated.
11681
11682 Example:
11683 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11684
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011685 Example:
11686
11687 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011688 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011689
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011690 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011691 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11692 # and reject everything else.
11693 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11694 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011695 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011696 tcp-request content reject
11697
11698 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011699 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11700 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11701 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011702 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011703
11704 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11705 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11706 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011707 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011708 tcp-request content reject
11709
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011710 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011711 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011712 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011713 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011714 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11715 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011716
11717 Example:
11718 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11719 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011720 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011721
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011722 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011723 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011724
11725 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011726 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011727 # protecting all our sites
11728 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011729 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11730 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011731 ...
11732 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11733
11734 backend http_dynamic
11735 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011736 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011737 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011738 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011739 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011740 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011741 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011743 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011744
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011745 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11746 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011747
11748
11749tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11750 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011752 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011753 Arguments :
11754 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11755 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11756 as explained at the top of this document.
11757
11758 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11759 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11760 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11761 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11762 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11763
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011764 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11765 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11766 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11767 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11768
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011769 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11770 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011771 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011772 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011773 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11774 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11775 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11776 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011777
11778 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11779 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11780 it pass through unaffected.
11781
11782 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11783 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11784 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011785 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011786 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11787 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011788 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11789 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11790 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011791
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011792 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011793 "timeout client".
11794
11795
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011796tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11797 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11799 no | no | yes | yes
11800 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011801 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11802 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011803
11804 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11805
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011806 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011807 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11808 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011809 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11810 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011811
11812 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11813
11814 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11815 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11816 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11817 inserted.
11818
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011819 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011820 - accept :
11821 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11822 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11823 the rules evaluation.
11824
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011825 - close :
11826 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11827 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11828 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11829 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11830 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11831 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011832 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011833 protocols.
11834
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011835 - reject :
11836 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11837 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011838 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011839
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011840 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11841 Sets a variable.
11842
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011843 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11844 Unsets a variable.
11845
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011846 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11847 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11848 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11849 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11850
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011851 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11852 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11853 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11854 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11855
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011856 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11857 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11858 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11859 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11860 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011861
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011862 - "silent-drop" :
11863 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011864 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011865 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11866 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11867 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11868 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11869 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011870 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11871 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011872 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11873 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011874 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011875 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11876 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11877 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11878 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11879
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011880 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11881 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11882
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011883 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11884 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11885 for changing the default action to a reject.
11886
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011887 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11888 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11889 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11890 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011891 period.
11892
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011893 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11894 declared inline.
11895
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011896 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11897 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011898 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011899 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11900 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011901 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011902 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011903 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011904 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11905 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011906 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011907 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11908 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011909
11910 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11911 followed by some converters.
11912
11913 Example:
11914
11915 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11916
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011917 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11918 <var-name>.
11919
11920 Example:
11921
11922 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11923
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011924 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11925 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11926 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11927 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11928 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11929
11930 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11931
11932 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11933
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011934 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11935
11936 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11937
11938
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011939tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11940 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11942 no | yes | yes | no
11943 Arguments :
11944 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11945 below.
11946
11947 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11948
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011949 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011950 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11951 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11952 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11953 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11954 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11955 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11956 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011957 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011958 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11959 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11960 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11961 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11962 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11963 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11964 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11965 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11966 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11967 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11968 instead.
11969
11970 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11971 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11972 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11973 rules which may be inserted.
11974
11975 Several types of actions are supported :
11976 - accept : the request is accepted
11977 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11978 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11979 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011980 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011981 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011982 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011983 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011984 - silent-drop
11985
11986 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11987 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11988 sections for a complete description.
11989
11990 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11991 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11992 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11993
11994 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11995 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11996 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11997 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11998 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11999
12000 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12001 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12002
12003 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12004 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12005 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12006
12007 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12008 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12009 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12010
12011 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12012 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12013 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12014
12015 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12016 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12017 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12018
12019 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12020
12021 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12022
12023
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012024tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12025 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12027 no | no | yes | yes
12028 Arguments :
12029 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12030 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12031 as explained at the top of this document.
12032
12033 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12034
12035
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012036timeout check <timeout>
12037 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12038 established.
12039
12040 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12041 yes | no | yes | yes
12042 Arguments:
12043 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12044 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12045 as explained at the top of this document.
12046
12047 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12048 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012049 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012050 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012051 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12052 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12053 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012054
12055 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12056 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12057
12058 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12059 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012060 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012061
12062 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12063 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12064 forget about it.
12065
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012066 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12067 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012068
12069
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012070timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012071 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12073 yes | yes | yes | no
12074 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012075 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012076 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12077 as explained at the top of this document.
12078
12079 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12080 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12081 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012082 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12083 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12084 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12085 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012086 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12087 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12088 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012089 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012090 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012091 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12092 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012093 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12094 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012095
12096 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12097 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12098 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12099 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012100 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012101 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12102
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012103 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012104
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012105 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012106
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012107
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012108timeout client-fin <timeout>
12109 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12111 yes | yes | yes | no
12112 Arguments :
12113 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12114 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12115 as explained at the top of this document.
12116
12117 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12118 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12119 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12120 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12121 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12122 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12123 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012124 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12125 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12126 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012127
12128 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12129 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12130 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12131
12132 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12133
12134
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012135timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012136 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12138 yes | no | yes | yes
12139 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012140 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012141 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12142 as explained at the top of this document.
12143
12144 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012145 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012146 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012147 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012148 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12149 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012150
12151 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12152 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12153 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12154 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012155 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012156 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12157
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012158 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012159
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012160
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012161timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12162 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12164 yes | yes | yes | yes
12165 Arguments :
12166 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12167 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12168 as explained at the top of this document.
12169
12170 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12171 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12172 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12173 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12174 once the request has started to present itself.
12175
12176 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12177 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12178 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12179 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12180 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12181
12182 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12183 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12184 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12185 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12186
12187 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12188 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012189 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012190 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12191 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012192 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012193
12194 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12195 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12196 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12197 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12198
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012199 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12200 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012201 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12202
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012203 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12204
12205
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012206timeout http-request <timeout>
12207 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012209 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012210 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012211 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012212 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12213 as explained at the top of this document.
12214
12215 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12216 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12217 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12218 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12219 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12220 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12221 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012222 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12223 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12224 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12225 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012226 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012227 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12228 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012229
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012230 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12231 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12232 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12233 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12234 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012235 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012236
12237 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12238 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012239 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012240 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12241 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12242
12243 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012244 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12245 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12246 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012247
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012248 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012249 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012250
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012251
12252timeout queue <timeout>
12253 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12255 yes | no | yes | yes
12256 Arguments :
12257 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12258 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12259 as explained at the top of this document.
12260
12261 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12262 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12263 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12264 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12265 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12266
12267 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12268 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12269 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12270 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12271
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012272 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012273
12274
12275timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012276 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12278 yes | no | yes | yes
12279 Arguments :
12280 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12281 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12282 as explained at the top of this document.
12283
12284 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12285 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12286 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12287 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12288 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12289 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12290 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12291
12292 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12293 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12294 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12295 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12296 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012297 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012298 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012299 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12300 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012301 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12302 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012303
12304 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12305 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12306 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12307 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012308 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012309 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12310
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012311 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012312
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012313
12314timeout server-fin <timeout>
12315 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12317 yes | no | yes | yes
12318 Arguments :
12319 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12320 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12321 as explained at the top of this document.
12322
12323 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12324 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12325 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12326 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12327 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12328 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12329 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12330 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12331 situations, it should not be needed.
12332
12333 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12334 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12335 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12336
12337 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12338
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012339
12340timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012341 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12343 yes | yes | yes | yes
12344 Arguments :
12345 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12346 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12347 as explained at the top of this document.
12348
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012349 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12350 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12351 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012352
12353 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12354 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12355 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12356 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012357 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012358
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012359 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012360
12361
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012362timeout tunnel <timeout>
12363 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12365 yes | no | yes | yes
12366 Arguments :
12367 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12368 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12369 as explained at the top of this document.
12370
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012371 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012372 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12373 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12374 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012375 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12376 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012377 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12378 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12379 specified.
12380
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012381 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12382 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12383 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12384 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12385 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12386 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12387 state.
12388
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012389 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12390 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12391 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12392 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012393 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012394
12395 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12396 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12397 forget about it.
12398
12399 Example :
12400 defaults http
12401 option http-server-close
12402 timeout connect 5s
12403 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012404 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012405 timeout server 30s
12406 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12407
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012408 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012409
12410
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012411transparent (deprecated)
12412 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012414 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012415 Arguments : none
12416
12417 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12418 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12419 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12420 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12421 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12422 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12423 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12424 appropriate server.
12425
12426 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12427
12428 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12429 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12430
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012431 See also: "option transparent"
12432
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012433unique-id-format <string>
12434 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12436 yes | yes | yes | no
12437 Arguments :
12438 <string> is a log-format string.
12439
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012440 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12441 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12442 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12443 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012444
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012445 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12446 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12447 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12448 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12449 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12450 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12451 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12452 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012453
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012454 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12455 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012456
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012457 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012458
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012459 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012460
12461 will generate:
12462
12463 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12464
12465 See also: "unique-id-header"
12466
12467unique-id-header <name>
12468 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12470 yes | yes | yes | no
12471 Arguments :
12472 <name> is the name of the header.
12473
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012474 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12475 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012476
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012477 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012478
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012479 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012480 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12481
12482 will generate:
12483
12484 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12485
12486 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012487
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012488use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012489 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12491 no | yes | yes | no
12492 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012493 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12494 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012495
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012496 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12497 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012498
12499 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12500 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12501 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012502 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012503 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012504 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12505 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012506
12507 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12508 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12509 assign the backend.
12510
12511 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12512 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12513 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12514 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12515 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12516 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12517
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012518 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012519 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012520 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12521 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12522 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12523
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012524 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12525 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12526 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12527 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12528 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12529 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12530 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12531 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12532 cannot be forced from the request.
12533
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012534 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012535 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12536 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12537
12538 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12539 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012540
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012541use-fcgi-app <name>
12542 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12544 no | no | yes | yes
12545 Arguments :
12546 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12547
12548 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012549
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012550use-server <server> if <condition>
12551use-server <server> unless <condition>
12552 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12554 no | no | yes | yes
12555 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012556 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12557 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012558
12559 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12560
12561 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12562 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12563 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12564
12565 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12566 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12567 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12568 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12569 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12570 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12571 matches will assign the server.
12572
12573 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12574 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12575 with the next rules until one matches.
12576
12577 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12578 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12579 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12580 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12581
12582 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12583 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12584 stripped.
12585
12586 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12587 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012588 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12589 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12590 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012591
12592 Example :
12593 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12594 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12595 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12596 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012597 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012598 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012599 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012600 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12601 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12602
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012603 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12604 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12605 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12606 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012607 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012608 and we fall back to load balancing.
12609
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012610 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012611
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012612
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100126135. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012614--------------------------
12615
12616The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12617depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12618settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12619written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12620described in this section.
12621
12622
126235.1. Bind options
12624-----------------
12625
12626The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12627as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12628no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12629parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12630while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12631provided immediately after the setting name.
12632
12633The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12634
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012635accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12636 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12637 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12638 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12639 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12640 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12641 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12642 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12643 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12644 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012645 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12646 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12647 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012648
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012649accept-proxy
12650 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012651 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12652 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012653 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12654 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12655 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12656 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012657 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012658 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12659 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012660 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12661 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012662
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012663allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012664 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012665 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012666 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012667 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12668 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012669
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012670alpn <protocols>
12671 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12672 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12673 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012674 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012675 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012676 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12677 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12678 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12679 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12680 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12681 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12682 preference, like below :
12683
12684 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012685
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012686backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012687 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012688 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12689
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012690curves <curves>
12691 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12692 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12693 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12694 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12695 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12696 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12697
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012698ecdhe <named curve>
12699 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012700 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12701 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012702
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012703ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012704 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12705 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12706 client's certificate.
12707
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012708ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12709 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12710 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12711 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12712 error is ignored.
12713
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012714ca-sign-file <cafile>
12715 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12716 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12717 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12718 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12719 'generate-certificates' for details.
12720
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012721ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012722 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12723 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12724 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12725 'generate-certificates' for details.
12726
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012727ca-verify-file <cafile>
12728 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12729 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12730 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12731 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12732 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12733
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012734ciphers <ciphers>
12735 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12736 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012737 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012738 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012739 information and recommendations see e.g.
12740 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12741 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12742 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12743
12744ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12745 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12746 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12747 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12748 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012749 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12750 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012751
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012752crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012753 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12754 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12755 to verify client's certificate.
12756
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012757crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012758 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12759 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12760 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12761 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12762 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012763 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12764 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012765
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012766 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12767 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12768
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012769 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12770 are loaded.
12771
12772 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012773 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12774 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12775 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12776 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12777 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12778 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12779 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012780 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012781
12782 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12783 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12784 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12785 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012786 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12787 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012788
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012789 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012790
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012791 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012792 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012793 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12794 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012795 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12796 clients).
12797
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012798 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12799 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12800 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12801 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12802 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12803 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12804 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12805 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12806 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12807 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12808 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12809 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12810 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12811
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012812 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12813 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12814 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12815 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12816 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12817
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012818 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12819 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12820 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12821 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012822
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012823 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
12824 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
12825 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012826
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012827crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012828 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012829 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012830 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012831 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012832
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012833crt-list <file>
12834 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012835 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12836 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012837
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012838 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12839
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012840 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12841 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12842 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12843 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12844 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012845
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012846 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012847 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
12848 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
12849 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
12850 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
12851 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012852 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12853 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12854 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012855
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012856 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
12857 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
12858 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012859
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012860 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12861
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030012862 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
12863 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
12864 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
12865 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
12866 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
12867 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
12868 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
12869 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012870
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012871 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012872 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012873 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012874 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012875 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012876 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012877
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012878defer-accept
12879 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12880 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12881 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012882 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012883 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12884 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12885 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12886 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12887 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12888 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12889 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12890
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012891expose-fd listeners
12892 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12893 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012894 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12895 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012896 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012897
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012898force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012899 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012900 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012901 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012902 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012903
12904force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012905 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012906 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012907 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012908
12909force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012910 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012911 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012912 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012913
12914force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012915 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012916 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012917 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012918
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012919force-tlsv13
12920 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12921 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012922 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012923
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012924generate-certificates
12925 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12926 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12927 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12928 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12929 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12930 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12931 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12932 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12933 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12934 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12935 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12936
12937 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12938 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012939 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012940 certificate is used many times.
12941
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012942gid <gid>
12943 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12944 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12945 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12946 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12947 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12948
12949group <group>
12950 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12951 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12952 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12953 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12954 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12955
12956id <id>
12957 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12958 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12959 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12960 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12961
12962interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012963 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12964 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12965 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12966 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12967 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12968 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012969 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12970 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12971 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12972 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12973 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12974 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012975
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012976level <level>
12977 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12978 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12979 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012980 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012981 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12982 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12983 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012984 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012985 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012986 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012987 all counters).
12988
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012989severity-output <format>
12990 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12991 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12992 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12993 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12994 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12995 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12996 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12997 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12998 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12999 rfc5424 convention.
13000
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013001maxconn <maxconn>
13002 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13003 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13004 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13005 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13006 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13007 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13008 eat all memory.
13009
13010mode <mode>
13011 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13012 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13013 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13014 UNIX sockets.
13015
13016mss <maxseg>
13017 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13018 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13019 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13020 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13021 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13022 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13023 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13024 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13025 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13026 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13027 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13028
13029name <name>
13030 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13031 page.
13032
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013033namespace <name>
13034 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13035 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13036 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13037 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13038
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013039nice <nice>
13040 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13041 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13042 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13043 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13044 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13045 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13046 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13047 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13048 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13049 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13050 one for an RDP socket.
13051
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013052no-ca-names
13053 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13054 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013055 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013056
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013057no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013058 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013059 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013060 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013061 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013062 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13063 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013064
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013065no-tls-tickets
13066 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13067 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13068 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013069 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13070 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013071 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13072 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13073 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013074
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013075no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013076 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013077 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013078 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013079 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013080 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13081 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013082
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013083no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013084 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013085 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013086 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013087 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013088 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13089 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013090
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013091no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013092 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013093 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013094 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013095 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013096 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13097 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013098
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013099no-tlsv13
13100 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13101 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13102 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13103 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013104 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13105 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013106
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013107npn <protocols>
13108 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13109 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13110 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013111 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013112 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013113 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13114 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13115 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13116 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13117 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013118
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013119prefer-client-ciphers
13120 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13121 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13122 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013123 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13124 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13125 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013126
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013127process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013128 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013129 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013130 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013131 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13132 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13133 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13134 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013135 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013136 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13137 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13138 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13139 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13140 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013141
13142 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13143
13144 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13145 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13146 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13147 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13148 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13149 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13150 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13151 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013152
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013153proto <name>
13154 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13155 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13156 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
13157 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013158 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013159 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013160 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013161 h2" on the bind line.
13162
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013163ssl
13164 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013165 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013166 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13167 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013168 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13169 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013170
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013171ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13172 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013173 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13174 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13175 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013176 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13177
13178ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013179 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13180 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13181 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13182 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013183
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013184strict-sni
13185 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13186 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13187 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13188 See the "crt" option for more information.
13189
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013190tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013191 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013192 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13193 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013194 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013195 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13196 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13197 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13198 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13199 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13200 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13201 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13202
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013203tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013204 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013205 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13206 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13207 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13208 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13209 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13210 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13211 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013212 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13213 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13214 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013215
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013216tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13217 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013218 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13219 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13220 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13221 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13222 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13223 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13224 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13225 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13226 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13227 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013228 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13229 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13230
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013231transparent
13232 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13233 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13234 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13235 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13236 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13237 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13238 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13239 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13240 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13241 so check for support with your vendor.
13242
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013243v4v6
13244 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13245 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13246 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13247 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013248 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013249
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013250v6only
13251 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13252 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13253 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013254 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13255 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013256
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013257uid <uid>
13258 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13259 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13260 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13261 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13262 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13263
13264user <user>
13265 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13266 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13267 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13268 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13269 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13270
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013271verify [none|optional|required]
13272 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13273 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13274 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13275 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13276 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013277 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13278 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13279 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13280 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013281
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200132825.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013283------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013284
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013285The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13286which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13287arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13288settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13289after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13290Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13291address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013293 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013294 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013295
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013296Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13297keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013299The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013300
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013301addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013302 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013303 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13304 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13305 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13306 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13307 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013308
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013309agent-check
13310 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013311 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013312 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13313 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13314 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013315
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013316 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013317 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013318 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13319 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13320 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013321
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013322 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13323 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13324 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13325 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13326 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013327
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013328 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013329 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013330
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013331 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13332 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13333 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013334
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013335 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13336 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13337 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013338
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013339 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013340 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13341 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13342 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13343 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013344 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013345 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013346
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013347 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13348 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013349
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013350 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13351 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13352 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13353 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13354 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13355 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13356 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13357 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13358 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013359
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013360 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13361 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013362 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13363 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13364 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013365 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013366
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013367 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013368 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013369
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013370agent-send <string>
13371 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13372 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13373 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13374 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13375 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13376
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013377agent-inter <delay>
13378 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13379 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13380
13381 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13382 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13383 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13384 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13385 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13386 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13387 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13388 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13389 of backends use the same servers.
13390
13391 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13392
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013393agent-addr <addr>
13394 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13395
13396 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13397 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13398 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13399 hostname, it will be resolved.
13400
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013401agent-port <port>
13402 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13403
13404 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13405
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013406allow-0rtt
13407 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013408 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13409 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013410
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013411alpn <protocols>
13412 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13413 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13414 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013415 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013416 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13417 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13418 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13419 now obsolete NPN extension.
13420 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13421 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13422
13423 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013425backup
13426 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13427 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13428 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13429 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013430 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13431 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013432
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013433ca-file <cafile>
13434 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13435 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13436 server's certificate.
13437
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013438check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013439 This option enables health checks on a server:
13440 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13441 considered available.
13442 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13443 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13444 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13445 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13446 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13447 set.
13448 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13449 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13450 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13451 exchanges succeed.
13452
13453 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13454 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13455 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13456 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13457 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013458 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013459 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13460
13461 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13462 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13463
13464 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13465 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13466
13467 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13468 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13469 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13470 available.
13471
13472 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13473 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13474 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13475
13476 Example:
13477 # simple tcp check
13478 backend foo
13479 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13480 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13481 backend foo
13482 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13483 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13484 backend foo
13485 option tcp-check
13486 tcp-check connect
13487 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013488
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013489check-send-proxy
13490 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13491 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13492 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13493 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13494 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13495 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13496 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13497
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013498check-alpn <protocols>
13499 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13500 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13501 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13502
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013503check-proto <name>
13504 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13505 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13506 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13507 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013508 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013509 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13510 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13511
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013512check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013513 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013514 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13515 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013516
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013517check-ssl
13518 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13519 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13520 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13521 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013522 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013523 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13524 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013525 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013526 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13527 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013528
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013529check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013530 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013531 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13532 for normal traffic.
13533
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013534ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013535 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13536 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13537 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013538 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13539 information and recommendations see e.g.
13540 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13541 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13542 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013543
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013544ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13545 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13546 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13547 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13548 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013549 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13550 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13551 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013552
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013553cookie <value>
13554 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13555 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13556 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13557 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13558 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13559 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13560 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13561
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013562crl-file <crlfile>
13563 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13564 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13565 to verify server's certificate.
13566
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013567crt <cert>
13568 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13569 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13570 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13571 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13572 certificate request.
13573
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013574disabled
13575 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13576 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13577 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13578 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13579 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013580 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013581
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013582enabled
13583 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13584 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13585 default value.
13586 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13587 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013588
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013589error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013590 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13591 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13592 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013593
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013594 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013595
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013596fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013597 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13598 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13599 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13600
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013601force-sslv3
13602 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13603 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013604 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013605 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013606
13607force-tlsv10
13608 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013609 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013610 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013611
13612force-tlsv11
13613 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013614 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013615 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013616
13617force-tlsv12
13618 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013619 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013620 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013621
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013622force-tlsv13
13623 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13624 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013625 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013626
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013627id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013628 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13629 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13630 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013631
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013632init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13633 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13634 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013635 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013636 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13637 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13638 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13639 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13640 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13641 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13642 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13643 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13644 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013645 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013646 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13647 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13648 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13649 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13650 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13651 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013652 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013653
13654 Example:
13655 defaults
13656 # never fail on address resolution
13657 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013659inter <delay>
13660fastinter <delay>
13661downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013662 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13663 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13664 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13665 between checks depending on the server state :
13666
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013667 Server state | Interval used
13668 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13669 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13670 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13671 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13672 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13673 or yet unchecked. |
13674 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13675 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13676 | "inter" otherwise.
13677 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013679 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13680 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13681 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13682 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013683 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13684 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13685 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13686 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13687 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013688
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013689log-proto <logproto>
13690 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13691 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13692 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13693 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13694
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013695maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013696 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13697 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013698 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13699 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013700 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13701 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13702 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13703 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13704
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013705 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13706 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13707 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13708 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13709 than 50 concurrent requests.
13710
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013711maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013712 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13713 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13714 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13715 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020013716 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
13717 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
13718 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
13719 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
13720 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
13721 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
13722 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013723
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013724max-reuse <count>
13725 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13726 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13727 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13728 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13729 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13730 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13731 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13732 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13733
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013734minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013735 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13736 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13737 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13738 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13739 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13740 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013741 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013742 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013743
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013744namespace <name>
13745 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13746 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13747 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13748 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13749
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013750no-agent-check
13751 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13752 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13753 default value.
13754 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13755 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13756
13757no-backup
13758 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13759 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13760 default value.
13761 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13762 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13763
13764no-check
13765 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13766 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13767 default value.
13768 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13769 "default-server" "check" setting.
13770
13771no-check-ssl
13772 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13773 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13774 default value.
13775 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13776 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13777
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013778no-send-proxy
13779 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13780 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13781 default value.
13782 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13783 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13784
13785no-send-proxy-v2
13786 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13787 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13788 default value.
13789 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13790 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13791
13792no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13793 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13794 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13795 default value.
13796 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13797 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13798
13799no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13800 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13801 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13802 default value.
13803 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13804 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13805
13806no-ssl
13807 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13808 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13809 default value.
13810 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13811 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13812
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010013813 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
13814 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
13815 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
13816
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013817no-ssl-reuse
13818 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13819 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13820 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13821 and for paranoid users.
13822
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013823no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013824 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13825 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013826 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013827
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013828 Supported in default-server: No
13829
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013830no-tls-tickets
13831 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13832 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13833 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013834 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13835 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013836 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13837 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13838 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013839 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013840
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013841no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013842 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013843 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13844 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013845 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13846 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013847 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013848
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013849 Supported in default-server: No
13850
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013851no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013852 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013853 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13854 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013855 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13856 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013857 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013858
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013859 Supported in default-server: No
13860
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013861no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013862 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013863 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13864 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013865 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13866 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013867 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013868
13869 Supported in default-server: No
13870
13871no-tlsv13
13872 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13873 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13874 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13875 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13876 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013877 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013878
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013879 Supported in default-server: No
13880
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013881no-verifyhost
13882 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13883 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13884 default value.
13885 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13886 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013887
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013888no-tfo
13889 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13890 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13891 default value.
13892 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13893 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13894
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013895non-stick
13896 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13897 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13898 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13899
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013900npn <protocols>
13901 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13902 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13903 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013904 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013905 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13906 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13907 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13908
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013909observe <mode>
13910 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13911 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13912 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13913 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13914 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13915 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013916 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013917
13918 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13919
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013920on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013921 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13922 Currently, four modes are available:
13923 - fastinter: force fastinter
13924 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13925 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13926 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13927 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13928
13929 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13930
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013931on-marked-down <action>
13932 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13933 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013934 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13935 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13936 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13937 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13938 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13939 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13940 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13941 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013942
13943 Actions are disabled by default
13944
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013945on-marked-up <action>
13946 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13947 Currently one action is available:
13948 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13949 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13950 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13951 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013952 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13953 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013954 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13955 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13956
13957 Actions are disabled by default
13958
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013959pool-low-conn <max>
13960 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13961 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13962 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13963 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13964 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13965 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13966 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13967 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13968 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13969 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13970 applying to "http-reuse".
13971
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013972pool-max-conn <max>
13973 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13974 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13975 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13976 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13977 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13978 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13979
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013980pool-purge-delay <delay>
13981 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013982 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013983 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013984
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013985port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013986 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13987 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13988 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13989 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13990 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13991 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13992
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013993proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013994 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13995 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13996 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13997 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013998 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013999 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014001redir <prefix>
14002 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14003 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14004 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14005 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14006 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14007 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14008 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14009 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014010 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014011 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014012 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14013 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14014 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14015 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14016
14017 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014019rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014020 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14021 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14022 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14023
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014024resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14025 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14026 server.
14027
14028 Available options:
14029
14030 * allow-dup-ip
14031 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14032 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14033 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14034 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14035 For such case, simply enable this option.
14036 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14037
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014038 * ignore-weight
14039 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14040 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14041 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14042
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014043 * prevent-dup-ip
14044 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14045 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14046 same fqdn.
14047 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14048
14049 Example:
14050 backend b_myapp
14051 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14052 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14053 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14054
14055 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14056 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14057 it
14058 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14059 different address
14060
14061 Default value: not set
14062
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014063resolve-prefer <family>
14064 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14065 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14066 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14067 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14068
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014069 Default value: ipv6
14070
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014071 Example:
14072
14073 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014074
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014075resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014076 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014077 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014078 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014079 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14080 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014081 configured network, another address is selected.
14082
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014083 Example:
14084
14085 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014086
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014087resolvers <id>
14088 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14089 hostname.
14090
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014091 Example:
14092
14093 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014094
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014095 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014096
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014097send-proxy
14098 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14099 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14100 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14101 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014102 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14103 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14104 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14105 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14106 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14107 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14108 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14109 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14110 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14111 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014112 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14113 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014114
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014115send-proxy-v2
14116 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14117 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14118 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14119 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014120 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14121 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14122 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14123 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014124
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014125proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014126 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14127 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14128
14129 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14130 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14131 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14132 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14133 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14134 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14135 connection is supported).
14136 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14137 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14138 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14139 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14140 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14141 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14142 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014143
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014144send-proxy-v2-ssl
14145 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14146 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14147 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14148 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14149 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14150 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14151 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014152 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14153 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014154
14155send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14156 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14157 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14158 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14159 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14160 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14161 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14162 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14163 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014164 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14165 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014166
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014167slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014168 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14169 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14170 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14171 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14172 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14173 parameters :
14174
14175 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14176 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14177
14178 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14179 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14180 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14181 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14182
14183 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14184 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14185 seen as failed.
14186
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014187sni <expression>
14188 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14189 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14190 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14191 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014192 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14193 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014194 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014195 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14196 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014197
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014198source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014199source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014200source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014201 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14202 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14203 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14204 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14205
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014206 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14207 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14208 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14209 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14210 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14211 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14212 server.
14213
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014214 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14215 specifying the source address without port(s).
14216
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014217ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014218 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14219 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14220 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14221 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14222 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14223 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014224 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14225 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014226
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014227ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14228 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14229 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14230 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14231
14232ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14233 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14234 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14235 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14236
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014237ssl-reuse
14238 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14239 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14240 default value.
14241 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14242 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14243
14244stick
14245 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14246 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14247 default value.
14248 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14249 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014250
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014251socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014252 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014253 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14254 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14255
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014256tcp-ut <delay>
14257 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14258 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14259 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014260 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014261 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14262 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14263 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14264 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14265 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14266 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14267 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14268 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14269 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14270
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014271tfo
14272 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14273 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14274 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14275 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14276 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014277 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014279track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014280 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14281 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14282 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14283 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014284 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14285
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014286tls-tickets
14287 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14288 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14289 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014290 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14291 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14292 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014293 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014294 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014295
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014296verify [none|required]
14297 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014298 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014299 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14300 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014301 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014302 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14303 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14304 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14305 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14306 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14307 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14308 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14309 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014310
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014311verifyhost <hostname>
14312 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014313 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14314 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14315 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14316 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14317 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14318 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14319 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14320 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014322weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014323 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14324 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14325 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014326 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14327 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14328 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14329 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14330 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14331 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014332
14333
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143345.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14335-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014336
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014337HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14338using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
14339configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014340This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14341can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14342workload.
14343This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14344resolution at run time.
14345Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14346carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14347
14348
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143495.3.1. Global overview
14350----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014351
14352As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14353different steps of the process life:
14354
14355 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14356 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14357 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14358
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014359 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14360 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014361
14362A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14363 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14364 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14365 resolution to know this new IP.
14366
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014367When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014368HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014369SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14370from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14371will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14372will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014373
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014374A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014375 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014376 first valid response.
14377
14378 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14379 servers return an error.
14380
14381
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143825.3.2. The resolvers section
14383----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014384
14385This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014386HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14387contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014388
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014389When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14390uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14391is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14392answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14393
14394When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014395used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014396
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014397 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14398 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14399 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014400
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014401 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14402 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014403
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014404 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14405 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14406 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014407
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014408For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14409following scenarios are possible:
14410
14411 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14412 ignored
14413
14414 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14415 applied
14416
14417 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14418 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14419
14420 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14421 retries the query with a new type
14422
14423 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14424 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014425
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014426As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14427a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014428<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014429
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014430
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014431resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014432 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014433
14434A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14435
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014436accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014437 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014438 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014439 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14440 by RFC 6891)
14441
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014442 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14443
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014444nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14445 DNS server description:
14446 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14447 <ip> : IP address of the server
14448 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14449
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014450parse-resolv-conf
14451 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14452 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14453 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14454
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014455hold <status> <period>
14456 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14457 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014458 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014459 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014460 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14461 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14462 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14463
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014464 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014465
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014466resolve_retries <nb>
14467 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14468 giving up.
14469 Default value: 3
14470
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014471 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14472 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14473 type.
14474
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014475timeout <event> <time>
14476 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14477 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14478 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014479 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14480 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014481 Default value: 1s
14482 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014483 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014484 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014485 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14486 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14487
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014488 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014489
14490 resolvers mydns
14491 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14492 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014493 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014494 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014495 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014496 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014497 hold other 30s
14498 hold refused 30s
14499 hold nx 30s
14500 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014501 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014502 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014503
14504
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200145056. Cache
14506---------
14507
14508HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14509(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14510RAM.
14511
14512The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14513this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14514
14515If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14516independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14517when we try to allocate a new one.
14518
14519The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14520
14521It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14522"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14523for more details.
14524
14525When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14526replaced by "<CACHE>".
14527
14528
145296.1. Limitation
14530----------------
14531
14532The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14533
14534- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010014535- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
14536 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
14537 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014538- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14539- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010014540- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
14541 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
14542 headers)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014543
14544- If the request is not a GET
14545- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14546- If the request contains an Authorization header
14547
14548
145496.2. Setup
14550-----------
14551
14552To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14553the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14554
14555
145566.2.1. Cache section
14557---------------------
14558
14559cache <name>
14560 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14561 size of cache is mandatory.
14562
14563total-max-size <megabytes>
14564 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14565 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14566
14567max-object-size <bytes>
14568 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14569 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14570 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14571
14572max-age <seconds>
14573 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14574 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14575 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14576 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14577 default.
14578
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010014579process-vary <0 or 1>
14580 Disable or enable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
14581 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
14582 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
14583 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
14584 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is 0 (disabled).
14585
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014586
145876.2.2. Proxy section
14588---------------------
14589
14590http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14591 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14592 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14593 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14594 after this one.
14595
14596http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14597 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14598 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14599 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14600 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14601
14602
14603Example:
14604
14605 backend bck1
14606 mode http
14607
14608 http-request cache-use foobar
14609 http-response cache-store foobar
14610 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14611
14612 cache foobar
14613 total-max-size 4
14614 max-age 240
14615
14616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146177. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14618----------------------------------
14619
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014620HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014621client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14622The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14623these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14624but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14625data called patterns.
14626
14627
146287.1. ACL basics
14629---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014630
14631The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14632content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14633from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14634simple :
14635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014636 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014637 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014638 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14639 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014641The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14642adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014643
14644In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014646 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014647
14648This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14649Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14650and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014651an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14652conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14653as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14654are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014655
14656ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14657'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14658which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14659
14660There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14661performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014663The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14664specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14665this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014666methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14667ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014668
14669Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14670 - boolean
14671 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14672 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14673 - string
14674 - data block
14675
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014676Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14677converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14678would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14679The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14680which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14681
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014682Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14683keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14684fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14685which are summarized in the table below :
14686
14687 +---------------------+-----------------+
14688 | Sample or converter | Default |
14689 | output type | matching method |
14690 +---------------------+-----------------+
14691 | boolean | bool |
14692 +---------------------+-----------------+
14693 | integer | int |
14694 +---------------------+-----------------+
14695 | ip | ip |
14696 +---------------------+-----------------+
14697 | string | str |
14698 +---------------------+-----------------+
14699 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14700 +---------------------+-----------------+
14701
14702Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14703matching method, see below.
14704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014705The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14706 - boolean
14707 - integer or integer range
14708 - IP address / network
14709 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14710 - regular expression
14711 - hex block
14712
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014713The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14714
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014715 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14716 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014717 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014718 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014719 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014720 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014721 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014723The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14724read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14725if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14726lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14727will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14728beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14729a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14730lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14731exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14732
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014733The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14734parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14735ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14736a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14737check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14738
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014739The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14740socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14741file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014743Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14744loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14745
14746 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14747
14748In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14749the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14750case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14751as well.
14752
14753The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14754sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14755do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14756methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14757is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014758obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014759followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14760default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14761that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14762string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14763
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014764The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14765By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14766string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14767resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14768server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014769waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014770flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14771function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014773There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14774sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14775be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014776
14777 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14778 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014779 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14780 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14781 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14782 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014783
14784 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14785 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014786 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014787
14788 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014789 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014790
14791 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014792 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014793
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014794 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014795 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14796
14797 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14798 binary or string samples.
14799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014800 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14801 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014803 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14804 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14805 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014807 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14808 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014810 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14811 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014813 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14814 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014816 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14817 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014818 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014820 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14821 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14822 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014823
14824For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14825request, it is possible to do :
14826
14827 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14828
14829In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14830buffer, one would use the following acl :
14831
14832 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14833
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014834On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14835possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14836
14837 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014839All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14840criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14841method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14842to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14843criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14844the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014846If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014847the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14848For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014850 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14851 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14852 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14853 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014854
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014855
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014856The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14857types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14858combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14859brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14860default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014862 +-------------------------------------------------+
14863 | Input sample type |
14864 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014865 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014866 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14867 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14868 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014869 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014870 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014871 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014872 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014873 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014874 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014875 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014876 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014877 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014878 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014879 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014880 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014881 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014882 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014883 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014884 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014885 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014886 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014887 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014888 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014889 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014890 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14891 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14892 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014893
14894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200148957.1.1. Matching booleans
14896------------------------
14897
14898In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14899Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14900When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14901that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14902
14903Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14904return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14905"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14906
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149087.1.2. Matching integers
14909------------------------
14910
14911Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14912enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14913to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14914
14915Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14916matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14917lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014918
14919For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14920unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14921representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14922
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014923As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14924two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14925instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14926ranges and operators.
14927
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014928For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014929operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14930Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14931of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014932
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014933Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014934
14935 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14936 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14937 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14938 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14939 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14940
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014941For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014942
14943 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14944
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014945This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14946
14947 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14948
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149507.1.3. Matching strings
14951-----------------------
14952
14953String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14954different forms :
14955
14956 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014957 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014958
14959 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014960 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014961
14962 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14963 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14964
14965 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14966 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14967
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014968 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014969 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14970 matches.
14971
14972 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14973 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14974 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014975
14976String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14977exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14978characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14979string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14980to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014981before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014982
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014983Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14984(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14985Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14986
14987Example:
14988 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14989 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14990
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149927.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14993---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014994
14995Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14996they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14997possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14998passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14999the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015000the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15001match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015002
15003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150047.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15005-------------------------------------
15006
15007It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15008not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15009a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15010to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15011digits may be used upper or lower case.
15012
15013Example :
15014 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15015 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15016
15017
150187.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15019---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015020
15021IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15022netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15023within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015024host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015025difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15026at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15027does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15028parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015029
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015030The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15031abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15032
15033 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15034 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15035 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15036 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15037 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15038 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15039 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15040 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15041
15042Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15043192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15044
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015045IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15046Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15047trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15048IPv6 patterns.
15049
15050HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15051following situations :
15052 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15053 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15054 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15055 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15056 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15057 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15058 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15059 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15060 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15061 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015063
150647.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15065----------------------------------
15066
15067Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15068combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15069
15070 - AND (implicit)
15071 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15072 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015074A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015076 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015078Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15079indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015081For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15082"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15083requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15084is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15085
15086 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015087 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15088 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15089 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015090
15091To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15092and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15093
15094 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15095 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15096 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15097 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15098
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015099 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015100 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15101 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15102 use_backend www if host_www
15103
15104It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15105expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15106be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15107the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15108
15109 The following rule :
15110
15111 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015112 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015113
15114 Can also be written that way :
15115
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015116 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015117
15118It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15119to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15120simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15121sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15122good use is the following :
15123
15124 With named ACLs :
15125
15126 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15127 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15128 monitor fail if site_dead
15129
15130 With anonymous ACLs :
15131
15132 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15133
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015134See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15135keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015136
15137
151387.3. Fetching samples
15139---------------------
15140
15141Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15142against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15143sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15144ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15145of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15146available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15147
15148This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15149Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15150compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15151deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15152
15153The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15154matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15155method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15156indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15157
15158As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15159when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15160mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15161the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15162ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15163
15164Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15165multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15166when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015167incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15168are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015169is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15170all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15171
15172Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15173 - name
15174 - name(arg1)
15175 - name(arg1,arg2)
15176
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015177
151787.3.1. Converters
15179-----------------
15180
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015181Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15182of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15183is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15184was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015185has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015186unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15187
15188These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15189sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15190the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015191support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015192
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015193A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15194support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15195supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15196(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15197bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015199The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015200
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001520151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15202 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15203 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15204 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15205 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15206 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15207
15208 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015209 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15210 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015211 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15212 frontend http-in
15213 bind *:8081
15214 default_backend servers
15215 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15216 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15217
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015218add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015219 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015220 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015221 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15222 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015223 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015224 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15225 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15226 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15227 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015228 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015229 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015230
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015231aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15232 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15233 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15234 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15235 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15236 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15237 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15238
15239 Example:
15240 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15241 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15242
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015243and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015244 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015245 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015246 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15247 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015248 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015249 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15250 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15251 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15252 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015253 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015254 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015255
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015256b64dec
15257 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15258 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
15259
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015260base64
15261 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015262 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015263 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
15264
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015265bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015266 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015267 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015268 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015269 presence of a flag).
15270
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015271bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15272 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15273 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015274 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015275
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015276concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15277 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15278 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15279 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15280 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15281 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15282 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15283 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15284 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15285 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15286 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015287 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015288 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015289 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15290 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015291
15292 Example:
15293 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15294 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15295 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015296 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015297 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15298
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015299cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015300 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15301 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015302
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015303crc32([<avalanche>])
15304 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15305 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15306 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15307 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15308 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15309 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15310 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15311 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15312 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15313 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015314 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15315
15316crc32c([<avalanche>])
15317 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15318 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15319 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15320 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15321 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15322 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15323 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15324 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015325
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015326cut_crlf
15327 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15328 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15329 updated.
15330
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015331da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015332 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15333 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15334 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15335 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015336 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015337 configuration language.
15338
15339 Example:
15340 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015341 bind *:8881
15342 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015343 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015344
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015345debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15346 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15347 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15348 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15349 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15350 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15351 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15352 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15353 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15354 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15355 printable sample types.
15356
15357 Example:
15358 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015359
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015360digest(<algorithm>)
15361 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15362 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15363
15364 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15365 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15366
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015367div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015368 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15369 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015370 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015371 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15372 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015373 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015374 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15375 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15376 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15377 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015378 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015379 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015380
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015381djb2([<avalanche>])
15382 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15383 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15384 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15385 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15386 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15387 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15388 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015389 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15390 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015391
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015392even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015393 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015394 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15395
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015396field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15397 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15398 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15399 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15400 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15401 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15402 fields.
15403
15404 Example :
15405 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15406 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15407 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15408 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15409 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015410
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015411fix_is_valid
15412 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
15413 Information eXchange):
15414
15415 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
15416 numeric
15417 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valide FIX version
15418 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
15419 - checks the MstType tag is the third tag.
15420 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
15421 checksum
15422
15423 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15424 the server can be parsed.
15425
15426 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
15427 message, false if not.
15428
15429 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
15430
15431 Example:
15432 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15433 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15434
15435fix_tag_value(<tag>)
15436 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
15437 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
15438 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
15439 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
15440 MsgType, SenderComID, TargetComID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
15441 added.
15442
15443 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15444 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
15445 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
15446 fix_is_valid converter.
15447
15448 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
15449
15450 Example:
15451 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15452 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15453 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
15454 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
15455 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
15456
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015457hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015458 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015459 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015460 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015461 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015462
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015463hex2i
15464 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015465 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015466
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015467htonl
15468 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15469 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15470 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15471 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15472
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015473hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15474 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15475 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15476 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15477 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15478
15479 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15480 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15481
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015482http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015483 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15484 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015485 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15486 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15487 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15488 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15489 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15490 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15491 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15492 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015493
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015494iif(<true>,<false>)
15495 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15496 string otherwise.
15497
15498 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015499 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015500
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015501in_table(<table>)
15502 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15503 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15504 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015505 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015506 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15507
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015508ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15509 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015510 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015511 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15512 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15513 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15514 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15515 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015516
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015517json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015518 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015519 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015520 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015521 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15522 of errors:
15523 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15524 bytes, ...)
15525 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15526 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15527
15528 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15529 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15530 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15531 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15532 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15533 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015534 - "ascii" : never fails;
15535 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15536 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015537 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015538 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015539 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15540 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15541
15542 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015543 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015544
15545 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015546 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015547 capture request header user-agent len 150
15548 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015549
15550 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15551 GET / HTTP/1.0
15552 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15553
15554 Output log:
15555 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15556
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015557language(<value>[,<default>])
15558 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15559 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15560 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15561 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15562 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15563 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15564 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15565 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15566 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015567 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015568 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15569 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015570
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015571 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015572
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015573 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15574 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015575
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015576 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15577 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15578 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15579 use_backend spanish if es
15580 use_backend french if fr
15581 use_backend english if en
15582 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015583
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015584length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015585 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15586 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15587 type. The result is of type integer.
15588
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015589lower
15590 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15591 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15592 type. The result is of type string.
15593
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015594ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15595 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15596 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15597 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15598 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15599 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15600 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15601
15602 Example :
15603
15604 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015605 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015606 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15607
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015608ltrim(<chars>)
15609 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15610 representation of the input sample.
15611
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015612map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15613map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15614map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15615 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15616 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15617 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15618 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15619 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15620 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15621 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15622 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015623
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015624 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15625 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15626 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015627
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015628 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015629 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015630
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015631 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15632 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15633 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15634 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015635 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15636 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015637 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15638 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15639 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15640 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15641 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15642 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15643 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15644 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015645 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15646 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15647 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015648 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15649 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15650 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15651 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15652 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015653
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015654 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15655 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15656 the corresponding match text.
15657
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015658 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15659 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15660 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15661 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15662 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015663
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015664 Example :
15665
15666 # this is a comment and is ignored
15667 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15668 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15669 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15670 | | | `---------- value
15671 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15672 | `---------------------------- key
15673 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15674
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015675mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015676 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15677 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015678 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015679 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015680 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015681 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15682 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15683 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15684 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015685 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015686 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015687
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010015688mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname or property ID>)
15689 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
15690 <packettype>.
15691 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
15692 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
15693 from.
15694 Supported string and integers can be found here:
15695 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
15696 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
15697
15698 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
15699 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
15700 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
15701 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
15702
15703 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
15704 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
15705 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15706 packets only):
15707 17: Session Expiry Interval
15708 33: Receive Maximum
15709 39: Maximum Packet Size
15710 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15711 25: Request Response Information
15712 23: Request Problem Information
15713 21: Authentication Method
15714 22: Authentication Data
15715 18: Will Delay Interval
15716 1: Payload Format Indicator
15717 2: Message Expiry Interval
15718 3: Content Type
15719 8: Response Topic
15720 9: Correlation Data
15721 Not supported yet:
15722 38: User Property
15723
15724 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
15725 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15726 packets only):
15727 17: Session Expiry Interval
15728 33: Receive Maximum
15729 36: Maximum QoS
15730 37: Retain Available
15731 39: Maximum Packet Size
15732 18: Assigned Client Identifier
15733 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15734 31: Reason String
15735 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
15736 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
15737 42: Shared Subscription Available
15738 19: Server Keep Alive
15739 26: Response Information
15740 28: Server Reference
15741 21: Authentication Method
15742 22: Authentication Data
15743 Not supported yet:
15744 38: User Property
15745
15746 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15747 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15748 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15749 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15750
15751 Example:
15752
15753 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15754 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15755 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
15756 if data_in_buffer
15757 # do the same as above
15758 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15759 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
15760 if data_in_buffer
15761
15762mqtt_is_valid
15763 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
15764
15765 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15766 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15767 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15768 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15769
15770 Example:
15771
15772 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15773 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
15774
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015775mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015776 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015777 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15778 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015779 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015780 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015781 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015782 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15783 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15784 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15785 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015786 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015787 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015788
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015789nbsrv
15790 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15791 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15792 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15793 map lookup.
15794
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015795neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015796 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15797 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15798 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15799 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015800
15801not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015802 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015803 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015804 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015805 absence of a flag).
15806
15807odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015808 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015809 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15810
15811or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015812 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015813 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015814 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15815 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015816 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015817 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15818 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15819 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15820 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015821 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015822 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015823
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015824protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15825 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15826 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15827 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15828 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15829 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15830 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15831 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15832 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15833 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15834 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15835 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15836
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015837regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015838 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15839 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15840 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15841 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15842 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15843 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15844 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15845 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15846 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015847 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15848 of characters with other ones.
15849
15850 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15851 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15852 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15853 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15854 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15855 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015856
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015857 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015858
15859 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15860 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15861 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015862 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015863
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015864 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15865 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15866
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015867 # capture groups and backreferences
15868 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020015869 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015870 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15871
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015872capture-req(<id>)
15873 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15874 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15875
15876 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015877 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15878 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015879
15880capture-res(<id>)
15881 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15882 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15883
15884 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015885 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15886 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015887
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015888rtrim(<chars>)
15889 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15890 of the input sample.
15891
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015892sdbm([<avalanche>])
15893 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15894 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15895 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15896 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15897 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15898 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15899 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015900 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15901 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015902
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015903secure_memcmp(<var>)
15904 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15905 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15906 match.
15907
15908 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15909 performed in constant time.
15910
15911 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15912 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15913
15914 Example :
15915
15916 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15917 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15918 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15919 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15920
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015921set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015922 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15923 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15924 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015925 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015926 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15927 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015928 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015929 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15930 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015931 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015932 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015933
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015934sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015935 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015936 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15937
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015938sha2([<bits>])
15939 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15940 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15941
15942 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15943 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15944
15945 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15946 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15947
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015948srv_queue
15949 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15950 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15951 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15952 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15953 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15954
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015955strcmp(<var>)
15956 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15957 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15958 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15959 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15960 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15961 shorter).
15962
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015963 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15964 strings in constant time.
15965
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015966 Example :
15967
15968 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15969 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15970 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15971
15972
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015973sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015974 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15975 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015976 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015977 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15978 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015979 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015980 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15981 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015982 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015983 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15984 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015985 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015986 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015987
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015988table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15989 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15990 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15991 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15992 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15993 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15994 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15995
15996
15997table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15998 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15999 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16000 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16001 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16002 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16003 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16004
16005table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16006 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16007 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016008 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016009 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16010 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16011
16012table_conn_cur(<table>)
16013 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16014 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16015 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16016 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16017 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16018
16019table_conn_rate(<table>)
16020 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16021 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16022 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16023 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16024 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16025
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016026table_gpt0(<table>)
16027 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16028 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16029 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16030 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16031 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16032
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016033table_gpc0(<table>)
16034 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16035 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16036 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16037 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16038 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16039
16040table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16041 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16042 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16043 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16044 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16045 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16046 sample fetch keyword.
16047
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016048table_gpc1(<table>)
16049 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16050 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16051 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16052 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16053 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16054
16055table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16056 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16057 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16058 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16059 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16060 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16061 sample fetch keyword.
16062
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016063table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16064 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16065 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016066 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016067 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16068 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16069
16070table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16071 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16072 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16073 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16074 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16075 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16076 keyword.
16077
16078table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16079 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16080 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016081 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016082 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16083 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16084
16085table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16086 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16087 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16088 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16089 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16090 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16091 keyword.
16092
16093table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16094 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16095 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016096 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016097 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16098 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16099 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16100 keyword.
16101
16102table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16103 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16104 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016105 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016106 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16107 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16108 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16109 keyword.
16110
16111table_server_id(<table>)
16112 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16113 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16114 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16115 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16116 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16117 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16118
16119table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16120 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16121 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016122 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016123 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16124 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16125 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16126 keyword.
16127
16128table_sess_rate(<table>)
16129 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16130 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16131 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16132 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16133 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16134 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16135 keyword.
16136
16137table_trackers(<table>)
16138 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16139 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16140 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16141 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16142 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16143 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16144 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16145 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16146 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16147 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16148
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016149upper
16150 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16151 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16152 type. The result is of type string.
16153
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016154url_dec([<in_form>])
16155 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16156 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16157 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16158 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16159 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16160 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016161
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016162ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016163 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016164 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16165 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16166 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016167 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16168 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16169 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16170 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016171 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016172 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16173 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016174
16175 Example:
16176 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16177 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16178
16179 message Point {
16180 int32 latitude = 1;
16181 int32 longitude = 2;
16182 }
16183
16184 message PPoint {
16185 Point point = 59;
16186 }
16187
16188 message Rectangle {
16189 // One corner of the rectangle.
16190 PPoint lo = 48;
16191 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16192 PPoint hi = 49;
16193 }
16194
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016195 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16196 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16197 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016198
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016199 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16200 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016201 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016202 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16203
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016204 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016205
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016206 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016207
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016208 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16209 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16210 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016211
16212 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16213 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16214 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16215
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016216 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16217 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16218 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016219
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016220
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016221unset-var(<var name>)
16222 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16223 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16224 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16225 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16226 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16227 response),
16228 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16229 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16230 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16231 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16232
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016233utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16234 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16235 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16236 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16237 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16238 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16239 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16240
16241 Example :
16242
16243 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016244 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016245 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16246
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016247word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16248 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16249 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16250 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016251 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016252 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16253 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16254
16255 Example :
16256 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16257 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16258 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16259 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16260 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016261 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016262
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016263wt6([<avalanche>])
16264 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16265 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16266 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16267 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16268 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16269 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16270 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016271 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16272 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016273
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016274xor(<value>)
16275 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016276 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016277 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016278 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016279 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016280 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16281 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016282 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016283 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16284 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016285 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016286 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016287
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016288xxh32([<seed>])
16289 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16290 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16291 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16292 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16293 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16294 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16295 as cryptographically secure.
16296
16297xxh64([<seed>])
16298 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16299 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16300 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16301 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16302 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16303 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16304 as cryptographically secure.
16305
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016306
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163077.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016308--------------------------------------------
16309
16310A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16311not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16312"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16313The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16314
16315always_false : boolean
16316 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16317 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16318
16319always_true : boolean
16320 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16321 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16322
16323avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016324 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016325 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16326 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16327 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16328 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16329 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16330 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16331 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16332 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16333 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16334 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16335 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16336 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16337 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016339be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016340 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16341 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16342 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16343 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016344 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16345
16346be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16347 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16348 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16349 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16350 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16351 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016352 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16353 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016354
16355 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16356 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16357 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016359be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16360 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16361 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16362 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016363 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016364 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16365 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016366
16367 Example :
16368 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16369 backend dynamic
16370 mode http
16371 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16372 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016373
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016374bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016375 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16376 of the string.
16377
16378bool(<bool>) : bool
16379 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16380 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016382connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16383 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016384 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016385 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16386 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016387
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016388 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016389 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016390 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16391
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016392 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16393 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016394
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016395 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016396 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016397 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016398 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016399 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016400 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016401 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016402
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016403 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16404 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016405 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016406 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016407
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016408cpu_calls : integer
16409 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16410 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16411 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16412 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16413 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16414 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16415
16416cpu_ns_avg : integer
16417 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16418 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16419 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16420 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16421 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16422 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16423 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16424 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16425 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16426 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16427 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16428
16429cpu_ns_tot : integer
16430 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16431 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16432 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16433 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16434 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16435 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16436 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16437 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16438 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16439 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16440 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16441 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16442 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16443
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016444date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016445 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016446
16447 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16448 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16449 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016450 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16451
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016452 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16453 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16454 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16455 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16456 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16457
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016458 Example :
16459
16460 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16461 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016462
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016463 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16464 # millisecond granularity
16465 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16466
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016467date_us : integer
16468 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16469 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16470 from the same timeval structure.
16471
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016472distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16473 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16474 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16475 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16476 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16477 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16478 list of supported tokens.
16479
16480distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16481 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16482 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16483 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16484 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16485 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16486 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16487 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16488 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16489 supported tokens.
16490
16491 Example :
16492 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16493 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16494 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16495 # send large files to the big farm
16496 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16497
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016498env(<name>) : string
16499 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16500 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16501 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16502 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16503 certain way.
16504
16505 Examples :
16506 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16507 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16508
16509 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16510 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016512fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16513 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016514 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16515 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016516 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16517 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016518 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016519 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16520 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016521
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016522fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16523 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16524 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16525 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016527fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16528 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16529 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16530 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16531 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16532 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16533 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16534 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16535 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016536
16537 Example :
16538 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16539 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16540 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16541 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16542 frontend mail
16543 bind :25
16544 mode tcp
16545 maxconn 100
16546 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16547 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16548 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16549 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016550
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016551hostname : string
16552 Returns the system hostname.
16553
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016554int(<integer>) : signed integer
16555 Returns a signed integer.
16556
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016557ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16558 Returns an ipv4.
16559
16560ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16561 Returns an ipv6.
16562
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016563lat_ns_avg : integer
16564 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16565 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16566 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16567 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16568 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16569 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16570 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16571 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16572 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016573 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16574 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16575 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16576 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16577 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16578 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016579
16580lat_ns_tot : integer
16581 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16582 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16583 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16584 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16585 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16586 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16587 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16588 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16589 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016590 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16591 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16592 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16593 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16594 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016595 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16596 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16597 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16598 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16599 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16600 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16601
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016602meth(<method>) : method
16603 Returns a method.
16604
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016605nbproc : integer
16606 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16607 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16608 and debugging purposes.
16609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016610nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16611 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16612 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16613 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016614 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16615 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16616 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016617
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016618prio_class : integer
16619 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16620 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16621 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16622
16623prio_offset : integer
16624 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16625 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16626 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16627 set-priority-offset".
16628
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016629proc : integer
16630 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16631 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16632 debugging purposes.
16633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016634queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016635 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16636 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16637 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016638 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16639 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16640 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16641 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16642 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16643
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016644rand([<range>]) : integer
16645 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16646 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16647 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16648 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16649 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16650
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016651uuid([<version>]) : string
16652 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16653 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16654 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016656srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16657 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16658 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16659 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16660 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16661 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016662 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16663 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16664
16665srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16666 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16667 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16668 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16669 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16670 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16671 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16672 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16673
16674 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16675 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016676
16677srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16678 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16679 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16680 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016681 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016682 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16683 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16684 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16685
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016686srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16687 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16688 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16689 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16690 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16691 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16692 fetch methods.
16693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016694srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16695 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16696 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016697 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016698 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16699 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016700 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016701 overloading servers).
16702
16703 Example :
16704 # Redirect to a separate back
16705 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16706 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16707 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16708
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016709srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16710 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16711 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16712 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16713
16714srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16715 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16716 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16717 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16718
16719srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16720 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16721 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16722 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16723
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016724stopping : boolean
16725 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16726 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16727 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16728
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016729str(<string>) : string
16730 Returns a string.
16731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016732table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16733 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16734 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16735
16736table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16737 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16738 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16739 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16740
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016741thread : integer
16742 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16743 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16744 and debugging purposes.
16745
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016746var(<var-name>) : undefined
16747 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016748 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16749 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016750 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016751 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16752 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016753 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016754 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16755 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016756 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016757 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016758
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200167597.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016760----------------------------------
16761
16762The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16763closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16764methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16765sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16766TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016767the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16768counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016769"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16770used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16771can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16772Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16773table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16774tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16775currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016776
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016777bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016778 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16779 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16780 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016782be_id : integer
16783 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016784 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16785 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016786
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016787be_name : string
16788 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016789 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16790 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016792dst : ip
16793 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16794 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16795 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16796 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016797 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16798 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16799 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16800 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16801 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16802 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016803
16804dst_conn : integer
16805 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16806 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16807 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16808 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16809 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16810 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16811 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16812 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016813
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016814dst_is_local : boolean
16815 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16816 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16817 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16818 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016819 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016820 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16821 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16822 it only once per connection.
16823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016824dst_port : integer
16825 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16826 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16827 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16828 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16829 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16830 an HTTP header.
16831
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016832fc_http_major : integer
16833 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16834 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16835 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16836
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016837fc_pp_authority : string
16838 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16839 if any.
16840
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016841fc_pp_unique_id : string
16842 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16843 if any.
16844
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016845fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16846 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16847 header.
16848
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016849fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16850 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16851 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16852 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16853 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16854 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16855 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16856
16857fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16858 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16859 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16860 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16861 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16862 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16863 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16864
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016865fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016866 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16867 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16868 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16869 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16870
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016871fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016872 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16873 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16874 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16875 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16876
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016877fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016878 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16879 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16880 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16881 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16882
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016883fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016884 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16885 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16886 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16887 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16888
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016889fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016890 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16891 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16892 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16893 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16894
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016895fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016896 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16897 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16898 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16899 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16900
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016901fe_defbe : string
16902 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16903 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016905fe_id : integer
16906 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016907 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016908 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16909
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016910fe_name : string
16911 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16912 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16913 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16914
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016915sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016916sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16917sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16918sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016919 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16920 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16921 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16922
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016923sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016924sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16925sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16926sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016927 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16928 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16929 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16930
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016931sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016932sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16933sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16934sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016935 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16936 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016937 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16938 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16939 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016940
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016941 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016942 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16943 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016944 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16945 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16946 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016947 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16948 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16949
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016950sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16951sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16952sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16953sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16954 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16955 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16956 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16957 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16958 when a first ACL was verified.
16959
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016960sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016961sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16962sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16963sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016964 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016965 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16966
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016967sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016968sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16969sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16970sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016971 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16972 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16973 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16974
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016975sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016976sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16977sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16978sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016979 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16980 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16981 See also src_conn_rate.
16982
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016983sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016984sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16985sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16986sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016987 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016988 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016989
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016990sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16991sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16992sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16993sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16994 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16995 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16996
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016997sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16998sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16999sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17000sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17001 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17002 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17003
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017004sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017005sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17006sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17007sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017008 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17009 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17010 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017011 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17012 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17013 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017014
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017015sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17016sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17017sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17018sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17019 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17020 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17021 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17022 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17023 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17024 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17025
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017026sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017027sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17028sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17029sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017030 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017031 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17032 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17033
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017034sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017035sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17036sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17037sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017038 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17039 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17040 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17041 src_http_err_rate.
17042
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017043sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017044sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17045sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17046sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017047 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017048 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17049 src_http_req_cnt.
17050
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017051sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017052sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17053sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17054sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017055 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17056 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17057 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17058 src_http_req_rate.
17059
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017060sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017061sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17062sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17063sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017064 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017065 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17066 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17067 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17068 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017069
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017070 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017071 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17072 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017073 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17074
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017075sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17076sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17077sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17078sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17079 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17080 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17081 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17082 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17083 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17084
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017085sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017086sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17087sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17088sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017089 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17090 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17091 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017092
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017093sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017094sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17095sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17096sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017097 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17098 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17099 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017100
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017101sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017102sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17103sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17104sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017105 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017106 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17107 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17108 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017109 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017110 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17111
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017112sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017113sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17114sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17115sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017116 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17117 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17118 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17119 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17120 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017121 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017122
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017123sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017124sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17125sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17126sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017127 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17128 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17129 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17130
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017131sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017132sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17133sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17134sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017135 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17136 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017137 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017138 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17139 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017140 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17141 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17142 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017144so_id : integer
17145 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17146 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17147 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017148
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017149so_name : string
17150 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17151 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17152 strings instead of integers.
17153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017154src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017155 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017156 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17157 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17158 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017159 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17160 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17161 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017162 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17163 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17164 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17165 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17166 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17167 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17168 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017169
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017170 Example:
17171 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17172 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017174src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17175 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17176 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17177 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017178 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017180src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17181 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17182 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017183 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017184 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017186src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17187 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17188 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17189 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17190 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17191 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17192 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017193
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017194 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017195 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17196 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17197 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17198 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017199 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017200 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17201 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17202
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017203src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17204 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17205 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17206 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17207 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17208 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17209 was verified.
17210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017211src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017212 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017213 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017214 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017215 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017217src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017218 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017219 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17220 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017221 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017223src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17224 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17225 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17226 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017227 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017229src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017230 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017231 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017232 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017233 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017234
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017235src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17236 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17237 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17238 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17239 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17240
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017241src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17242 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17243 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17244 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17245 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017247src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017248 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017249 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017250 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17251 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017252 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17253 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17254 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017255
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017256src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17257 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17258 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17259 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17260 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17261 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17262 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17263 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017265src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017266 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017267 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017268 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017269 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017270 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017272src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17273 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17274 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17275 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17276 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017277 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017279src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017280 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017281 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17282 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017283 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017285src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17286 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17287 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17288 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017289 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017290 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017292src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17293 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17294 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17295 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017296 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017297 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17298 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017299
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017300 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017301 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017302 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017303 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017304
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017305src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17306 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17307 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17308 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17309 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17310 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17311 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17312
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017313src_is_local : boolean
17314 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17315 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17316 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17317 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017318 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017319 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17320 once per connection.
17321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017322src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017323 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17324 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17325 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17326 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17327 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017329src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017330 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17331 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17332 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17333 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17334 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017336src_port : integer
17337 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17338 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17339 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17340 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017342src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017343 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017344 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17345 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17346 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017347 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017349src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17350 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17351 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17352 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17353 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017354 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017356src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17357 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17358 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17359 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17360 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17361 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17362 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17363 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17364 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017365
17366 Example :
17367 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17368 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17369 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17370 listen ssh
17371 bind :22
17372 mode tcp
17373 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017374 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017375 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017376 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017378srv_id : integer
17379 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17380 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017381 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017382
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017383srv_name : string
17384 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
17385 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017386 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017387
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200173887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017389----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020017390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017391The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
17392closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
17393when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
17394usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017395future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017396
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001739751d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
17398 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17399 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17400 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
17401 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17402 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17403
17404 Example :
17405 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17406 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17407 # the request.
17408 frontend http-in
17409 bind *:8081
17410 default_backend servers
17411 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17412 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17413
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017414ssl_bc : boolean
17415 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17416 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017417 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17418 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017419
17420ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17421 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017422 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17423 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017424
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017425ssl_bc_alpn : string
17426 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17427 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017428 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017429 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17430 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17431 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17432 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17433 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017434 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17435 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017436
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017437ssl_bc_cipher : string
17438 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017439 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17440 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017441
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017442ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17443 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17444 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17445 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017446 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017447
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017448ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17449 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17450 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017451 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17452 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017453
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017454ssl_bc_npn : string
17455 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17456 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017457 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017458 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17459 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17460 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17461 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017462 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17463 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017464
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017465ssl_bc_protocol : string
17466 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017467 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17468 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017469
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017470ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017471 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017472 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017473 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17474 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017475
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017476ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17477 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17478 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17479 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017480 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017481
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017482ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17483 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17484 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017485 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17486 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017487
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017488ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17489 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17490 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17491 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017492 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017493
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017494ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17495 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017496 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17497 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017499ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17500 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17501 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17502 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17503 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17504 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017506ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17507 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17508 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17509 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17510 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017511
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017512ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017513 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17514 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17515 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17516 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17517 does not support resumed sessions.
17518
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017519ssl_c_der : binary
17520 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17521 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17522 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017524ssl_c_err : integer
17525 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17526 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17527 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17528 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17529 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017530
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017531ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017532 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17533 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17534 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17535 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17536 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17537 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17538 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17539 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017540 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17541 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17542 LDAP v3.
17543 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17544 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017546ssl_c_key_alg : string
17547 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17548 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17549 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017551ssl_c_notafter : string
17552 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17553 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17554 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017556ssl_c_notbefore : string
17557 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17558 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17559 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017560
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017561ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017562 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17563 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17564 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17565 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17566 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17567 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17568 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17569 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017570 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17571 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17572 LDAP v3.
17573 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17574 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017576ssl_c_serial : binary
17577 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17578 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17579 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017581ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17582 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17583 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17584 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017585 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17586 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17587
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017588 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017589 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017591ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17592 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17593 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17594 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017596ssl_c_used : boolean
17597 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17598 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017600ssl_c_verify : integer
17601 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17602 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17603 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17604 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017606ssl_c_version : integer
17607 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17608 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017609
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017610ssl_f_der : binary
17611 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17612 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17613 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17614
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017615ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017616 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17617 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17618 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17619 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017620 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017621 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17622 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17623 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017624 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17625 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17626 LDAP v3.
17627 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17628 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017630ssl_f_key_alg : string
17631 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17632 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17633 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017635ssl_f_notafter : string
17636 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17637 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17638 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017640ssl_f_notbefore : string
17641 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17642 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17643 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017644
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017645ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017646 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17647 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17648 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17649 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17650 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17651 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17652 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17653 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017654 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17655 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17656 LDAP v3.
17657 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17658 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017660ssl_f_serial : binary
17661 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17662 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17663 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017664
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017665ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17666 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17667 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17668 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017670ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17671 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17672 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17673 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017675ssl_f_version : integer
17676 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17677 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17678
17679ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017680 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17681 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17682 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017684 Example :
17685 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17686 listen http-https
17687 bind :80
17688 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17689 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17690
17691ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17692 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17693 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17694
17695ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017696 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017697 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17698 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17699 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17700 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17701 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17702 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17703 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17704 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017706ssl_fc_cipher : string
17707 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17708 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017709
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017710ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17711 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17712 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017713 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017714
17715ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17716 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17717 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017718 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017719
17720ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17721 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17722 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17723 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017724 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017725 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017726
17727ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17728 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17729 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017730 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017731
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017732ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17733 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17734 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17735 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17736
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017737ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17738 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17739 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17740 transport layer.
17741 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17742 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17743 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17744 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17745
17746ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17747 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17748 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17749 transport layer.
17750 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17751 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17752 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17753 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17754
17755ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17756 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17757 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17758 transport layer.
17759 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17760 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17761 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17762 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17763
17764ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17765 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17766 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17767 transport layer.
17768 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17769 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17770 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17771 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17772
17773ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17774 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17775 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17776 transport layer.
17777 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17778 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17779 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17780 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017782ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017783 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17784 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017785 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17786 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17787 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17788 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017789
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017790ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17791 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17792 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17793 wait until the handshake happened.
17794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017795ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17796 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017797 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17798 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017799 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017800 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017801
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017802ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017803 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017804 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17805 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017807ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017808 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017809 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17810 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17811 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17812 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17813 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17814 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17815 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017817ssl_fc_protocol : string
17818 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17819 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017820
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017821ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017822 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017823 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17824 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017825
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017826ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17827 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17828 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17829 transport layer.
17830 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17831 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17832 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17833 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17834
17835ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17836 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17837 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17838 transport layer.
17839 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17840 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17841 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17842 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17843
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017844ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17845 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17846 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17847 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017849ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17850 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17851 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17852 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17853 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017854
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017855ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17856 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17857 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17858 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17859 BoringSSL.
17860
17861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017862ssl_fc_sni : string
17863 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17864 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17865 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17866 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17867 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17868
17869 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17870 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17871 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017872 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017873 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017875 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017876 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17877 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017879ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17880 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17881 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017882
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017883ssl_s_der : binary
17884 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17885 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17886 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17887
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017888ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17889 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17890 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17891 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17892 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17893 does not support resumed sessions.
17894
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017895ssl_s_key_alg : string
17896 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17897 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17898 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17899
17900ssl_s_notafter : string
17901 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17902 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17903 transport layer.
17904
17905ssl_s_notbefore : string
17906 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17907 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17908 transport layer.
17909
17910ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17911 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17912 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17913 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17914 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17915 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17916 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017917 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17918 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017919 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17920 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17921 LDAP v3.
17922 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17923 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17924
17925ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17926 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17927 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17928 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17929 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17930 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17931 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017932 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17933 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017934 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17935 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17936 LDAP v3.
17937 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17938 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17939
17940ssl_s_serial : binary
17941 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17942 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17943 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17944
17945ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17946 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17947 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17948 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17949
17950ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17951 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17952 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17953 layer.
17954
17955ssl_s_version : integer
17956 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17957 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017958
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200179597.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017960------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017962Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17963sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17964only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17965For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17966be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17967can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17968sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17969for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17970content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017972payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017973 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017974 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17975 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017977payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17978 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017979 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017980 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017981
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017982req.hdrs : string
17983 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17984 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17985 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17986 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17987
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017988req.hdrs_bin : binary
17989 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17990 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17991 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17992 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17993 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17994 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17995
17996 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17997
17998 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17999 str: <int:length><bytes>
18000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018001req.len : integer
18002req_len : integer (deprecated)
18003 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18004 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18005 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18006 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18007 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18008 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18009 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18010 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018012req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18013 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018014 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18015 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18016 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18017 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018019 ACL alternatives :
18020 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018022req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18023 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18024 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18025 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18026 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018028 ACL alternatives :
18029 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018031 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018033req.proto_http : boolean
18034req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18035 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18036 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18037 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18038 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18039 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18040 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18041 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018043 Example:
18044 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18045 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18046 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018047 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018049req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18050rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18051 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18052 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18053 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18054 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18055 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18056 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18057 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018059 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18060 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18061 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18062 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18063 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18064 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018066 ACL derivatives :
18067 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018069 Example :
18070 listen tse-farm
18071 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18072 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18073 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18074 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18075 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18076 persist rdp-cookie
18077 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18078 # This is only useful makes sense if
18079 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18080 stick-table type string size 204800
18081 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18082 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18083 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018085 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18086 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018088req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18089rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18090 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18091 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18092 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18093 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018095 ACL derivatives :
18096 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018097
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018098req.ssl_alpn : string
18099 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18100 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18101 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18102 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18103 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18104 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018105 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018106
18107 Examples :
18108 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18109 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18110 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018111 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018112 default_backend bk_default
18113
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018114req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18115 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18116 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018117 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18118 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18119 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18120 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18121 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018123req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18124req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18125 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18126 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18127 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18128 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18129 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18130 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18131 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018133req.ssl_sni : string
18134req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18135 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18136 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18137 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18138 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18139 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018140 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18141 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18142 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18143 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18144 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18145 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18146 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18147 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18148 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018150 ACL derivatives :
18151 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018153 Examples :
18154 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18155 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18156 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18157 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18158 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018159
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018160req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18161 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18162 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18163 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18164 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18165 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18166 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18167 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18168 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18169 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018171req.ssl_ver : integer
18172req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18173 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18174 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18175 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18176 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18177 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18178 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18179 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018180 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018181 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018183 ACL derivatives :
18184 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018185
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018186res.len : integer
18187 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18188 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18189 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18190 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18191 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18192 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18193 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018194 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018196res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18197 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018198 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018199 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018200 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018201 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018203res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18204 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18205 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18206 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018207 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18208 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018210 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018211
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018212res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18213rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18214 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18215 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18216 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18217 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18218 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18219 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18220 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018222wait_end : boolean
18223 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18224 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018225 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018226 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18227 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018228 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018229 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18230 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018232 Examples :
18233 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18234 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18235 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018237 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18238 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18239 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18240 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18241 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18242 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18243 tcp-request content reject
18244
18245
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200182467.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018247--------------------------------------
18248
18249It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18250This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18251data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18252its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18253HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18254content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18255to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18256more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18257response are indexed.
18258
18259base : string
18260 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18261 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18262 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18263 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18264 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18265 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18266 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18267 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18268
18269 ACL derivatives :
18270 base : exact string match
18271 base_beg : prefix match
18272 base_dir : subdir match
18273 base_dom : domain match
18274 base_end : suffix match
18275 base_len : length match
18276 base_reg : regex match
18277 base_sub : substring match
18278
18279base32 : integer
18280 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18281 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18282 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018283 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18284 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18285 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018286
18287base32+src : binary
18288 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18289 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18290 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18291 per-URL counters.
18292
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018293capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18294 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18295 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18296 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18297
18298capture.req.method : string
18299 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18300 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18301 because it's allocated.
18302
18303capture.req.uri : string
18304 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18305 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18306 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18307 allocated.
18308
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018309capture.req.ver : string
18310 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18311 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18312 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18313
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018314capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18315 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18316 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18317 The first entry is an index of 0.
18318 See also: "capture response header"
18319
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018320capture.res.ver : string
18321 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18322 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18323 persistent flag.
18324
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018325req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018326 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18327 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18328 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018329
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018330req.body_param([<name>) : string
18331 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18332 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18333 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18334 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18335 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18336 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18337 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18338 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18339 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18340 given.
18341
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018342req.body_len : integer
18343 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18344 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018345 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18346 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018347
18348req.body_size : integer
18349 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018350 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18351 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018353req.cook([<name>]) : string
18354cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18355 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18356 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18357 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18358 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18359 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18360 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18361 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18362 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18363
18364 ACL derivatives :
18365 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18366 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18367 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18368 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18369 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18370 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18371 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18372 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018374req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18375cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18376 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18377 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018379req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18380cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18381 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18382 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
18383 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
18384 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018386cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18387 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18388 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
18389 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
18390 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018391 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018392 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
18393 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
18394 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
18395 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018397hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18398 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
18399 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
18400 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
18401 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018402 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018404req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
18405 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18406 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18407 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18408 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18409 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18410 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
18411 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
18412 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018414req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18415 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18416 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18417 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18418 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018420req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18421 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18422 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18423 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18424 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18425 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18426 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
18427 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
18428 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000018429 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018430 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018431 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018433 ACL derivatives :
18434 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18435 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18436 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18437 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18438 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18439 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18440 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18441 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18442
18443req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18444hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18445 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18446 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
18447 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
18448 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
18449 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
18450 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
18451 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
18452 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
18453 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
18454
18455req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18456hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18457 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18458 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18459 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
18460 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18461 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018462 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018463 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
18464 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
18465
18466req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18467hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18468 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18469 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18470 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
18471 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18472 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18473 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18474 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
18475
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018476
18477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018478http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18479 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18480 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18481 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18482 basic auth is supported.
18483
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018484http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18485 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18486 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18487 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18488 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018489 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18490 basic auth is supported.
18491
18492 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018493 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18494 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18495 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18496 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018497
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018498http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018499 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18500 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18501 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018502
18503http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018504 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18505 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18506 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018507
18508http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018509 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18510 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18511 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018513http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018514 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18515 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018516 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18517 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018519method : integer + string
18520 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18521 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18522 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18523 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18524 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18525 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18526 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018528 ACL derivatives :
18529 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018531 Example :
18532 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18533 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18534 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018536path : string
18537 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18538 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18539 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18540 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18541 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018542 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018543 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018545 ACL derivatives :
18546 path : exact string match
18547 path_beg : prefix match
18548 path_dir : subdir match
18549 path_dom : domain match
18550 path_end : suffix match
18551 path_len : length match
18552 path_reg : regex match
18553 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018554
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018555pathq : string
18556 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18557 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18558 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18559 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18560 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18561 result in both cases.
18562
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018563query : string
18564 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18565 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18566 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18567 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018568 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018569 which stops before the question mark.
18570
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018571req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18572 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18573 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18574 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18575 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018577req.ver : string
18578req_ver : string (deprecated)
18579 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18580 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18581 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018583 ACL derivatives :
18584 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018585
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018586res.body : binary
18587 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18588 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18589 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18590 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18591
18592res.body_len : integer
18593 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18594 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18595 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18596 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18597
18598res.body_size : integer
18599 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18600 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18601 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18602 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
18603 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
18604 based expect rules.
18605
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010018606res.cache_hit : boolean
18607 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
18608 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
18609
18610res.cache_name : string
18611 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
18612 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
18613 empty string.
18614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018615res.comp : boolean
18616 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18617 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18618 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018620res.comp_algo : string
18621 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18622 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18623 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018625res.cook([<name>]) : string
18626scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18627 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18628 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018629 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
18630 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018632 ACL derivatives :
18633 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018635res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18636scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18637 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18638 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018639 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
18640 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018642res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18643scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18644 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18645 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018646 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
18647 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018649res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18650 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18651 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18652 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18653 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18654 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
18655 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
18656 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
18657 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018658 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018660res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18661 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18662 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18663 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18664 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018665 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
18666 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018668res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18669shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
18670 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18671 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18672 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18673 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18674 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
18675 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
18676 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018677 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
18678 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018680 ACL derivatives :
18681 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18682 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18683 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18684 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18685 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18686 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18687 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18688 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18689
18690res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18691shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18692 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18693 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18694 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
18695 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018696 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018698res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18699shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18700 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
18701 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
18702 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
18703 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
18704 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018705 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
18706 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018707
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018708res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18709 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18710 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18711 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018712 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18713 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018715res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18716shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18717 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18718 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18719 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18720 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18721 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018722 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18723 based expect rules.
18724
18725res.hdrs : string
18726 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18727 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18728 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18729 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18730 based expect rules.
18731
18732res.hdrs_bin : binary
18733 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18734 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18735 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18736 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18737 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18738 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18739 (length of 0 for both).
18740
18741 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18742
18743 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18744 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018746res.ver : string
18747resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18748 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018749 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18750 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018752 ACL derivatives :
18753 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018755set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18756 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18757 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018758 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018759 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018761 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18762 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018764status : integer
18765 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18766 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018767 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18768 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018769
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018770unique-id : string
18771 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18772 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18773 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18774 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18775 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18776 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018778url : string
18779 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18780 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18781 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18782 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18783 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18784 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18785 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018787 ACL derivatives :
18788 url : exact string match
18789 url_beg : prefix match
18790 url_dir : subdir match
18791 url_dom : domain match
18792 url_end : suffix match
18793 url_len : length match
18794 url_reg : regex match
18795 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018797url_ip : ip
18798 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18799 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18800 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18801 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18802 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18803 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18804 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018806url_port : integer
18807 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18808 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18809 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18810 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018811
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018812urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18813url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018814 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18815 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018816 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18817 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18818 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18819 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018820 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18821 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018822 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18823 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018825 ACL derivatives :
18826 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18827 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18828 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18829 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18830 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18831 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18832 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18833 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018834
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018836 Example :
18837 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18838 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18839 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18840 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018841
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018842urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018843 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18844 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18845 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018846
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018847url32 : integer
18848 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18849 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18850 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18851 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18852 is an unsigned integer.
18853
18854url32+src : binary
18855 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18856 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18857 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18858
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018859
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200188607.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018861---------------------------------------
18862
18863This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18864used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18865purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18866There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18867or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18868any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18869for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18870
18871internal.htx.data : integer
18872 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18873 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18874
18875internal.htx.free : integer
18876 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18877 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18878
18879internal.htx.free_data : integer
18880 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18881 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18882
18883internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18884 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18885 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18886 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18887
18888internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18889 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18890 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18891
18892internal.htx.size : integer
18893 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18894 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18895
18896internal.htx.used : integer
18897 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18898 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18899 direction.
18900
18901internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18902 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18903 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18904 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18905 of the special value :
18906 * head : The oldest inserted block
18907 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018908 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018909
18910internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18911 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18912 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18913 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18914 integer or one of the special value :
18915 * head : The oldest inserted block
18916 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018917 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018918
18919internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18920 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18921 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18922 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18923 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18924
18925 * head : The oldest inserted block
18926 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018927 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018928
18929internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18930 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18931 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18932 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18933 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18934
18935 * head : The oldest inserted block
18936 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018937 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018938
18939internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18940 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18941 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18942 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18943 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18944
18945 * head : The oldest inserted block
18946 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018947 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018948
18949internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18950 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18951 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18952 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18953 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18954
18955 * head : The oldest inserted block
18956 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018957 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018958
18959internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18960 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18961 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18962 it returns false.
18963
18964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200189657.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018966---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018968Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18969every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018970order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018971
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018972ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18973---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018974FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018975HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018976HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18977HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018978HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18979HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18980HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18981HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18982LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018983METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018984METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018985METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18986METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18987METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18988METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018989METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018990METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018991RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018992REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018993TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018994WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18995---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018996
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018997
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189988. Logging
18999----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019000
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019001One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19002provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19003very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19004provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19005state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019006to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019007headers.
19008
19009In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19010about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19011send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19012
19013 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19014 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19015 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19016 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19017 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019018 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019019 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019020
19021The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19022allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19023as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19024while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19025real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19026delay.
19027
19028
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190298.1. Log levels
19030---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019031
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019032TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019033source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019034HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19035in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19036track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19037syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19038about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019039
19040
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190418.2. Log formats
19042----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019043
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019044HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019045and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19046slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19047options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019048
19049 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19050 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19051 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19052 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19053 extents.
19054
19055 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19056 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19057 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19058 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19059 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19060
19061 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19062 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19063 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19064 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19065 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19066
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019067 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19068 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19069 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19070 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19071
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019072 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19073
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019074Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19075specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19076field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19077servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19078always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19079identifier.
19080
19081Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19082 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19083 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19084 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19085 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19086
19087
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190888.2.1. Default log format
19089-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019090
19091This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19092as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19093format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19094
19095 Example :
19096 listen www
19097 mode http
19098 log global
19099 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19100
19101 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19102 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19103 (www/HTTP)
19104
19105 Field Format Extract from the example above
19106 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19107 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19108 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19109 4 'to' to
19110 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19111 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19112
19113Detailed fields description :
19114 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19115 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19116 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19117 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19118 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19119 and processed the connection.
19120 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19121
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019122In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19123"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19124connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19125
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019126It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19127will eventually disappear.
19128
19129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191308.2.2. TCP log format
19131---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019132
19133The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19134is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19135information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19136counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19137emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19138environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19139the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19140sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019141specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19142not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19143fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19144marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019145
19146 Example :
19147 frontend fnt
19148 mode tcp
19149 option tcplog
19150 log global
19151 default_backend bck
19152
19153 backend bck
19154 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19155
19156 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19157 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19158 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19159
19160 Field Format Extract from the example above
19161 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19162 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19163 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19164 4 frontend_name fnt
19165 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19166 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19167 7 bytes_read* 212
19168 8 termination_state --
19169 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19170 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19171
19172Detailed fields description :
19173 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019174 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19175 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19176 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019177 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019178 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019179 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019180
19181 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019182 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19183 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19184 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019185
19186 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19187 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19188 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019189 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19190 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19191 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19192 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019193
19194 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19195 and processed the connection.
19196
19197 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19198 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19199 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19200 applications.
19201
19202 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19203 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19204 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19205 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19206 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19207
19208 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19209 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19210 See "Timers" below for more details.
19211
19212 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19213 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19214 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19215 "Timers" below for more details.
19216
19217 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019218 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019219 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19220 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19221 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19222 details.
19223
19224 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19225 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19226 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19227 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19228 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19229
19230 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19231 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19232 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19233 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19234 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19235 for more details.
19236
19237 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019238 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019239 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19240 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19241 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019242 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019243
19244 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19245 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19246 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19247 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19248 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19249 caused by a denial of service attack.
19250
19251 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19252 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19253 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19254 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19255 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19256 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19257 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19258 denial of service attack.
19259
19260 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19261 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19262 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19263 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19264 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19265 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19266 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19267 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19268 be processed than on other servers.
19269
19270 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19271 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19272 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19273 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19274 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19275 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19276 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19277 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19278 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19279 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19280 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19281 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19282 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19283
19284 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19285 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19286 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19287 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19288 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19289 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019290 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019291 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19292
19293 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19294 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19295 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19296 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19297 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19298 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019299 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019300 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19301 occurs.
19302
19303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193048.2.3. HTTP log format
19305----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019306
19307The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19308is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19309the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19310are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19311emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19312generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19313"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19314which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019315frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19316is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019317
19318Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19319slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19320with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19321
19322 Example :
19323 frontend http-in
19324 mode http
19325 option httplog
19326 log global
19327 default_backend bck
19328
19329 backend static
19330 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19331
19332 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19333 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19334 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019335 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019336
19337 Field Format Extract from the example above
19338 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
19339 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019340 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019341 4 frontend_name http-in
19342 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019343 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019344 7 status_code 200
19345 8 bytes_read* 2750
19346 9 captured_request_cookie -
19347 10 captured_response_cookie -
19348 11 termination_state ----
19349 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
19350 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19351 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
19352 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
19353 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019354
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019355Detailed fields description :
19356 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019357 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19358 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19359 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019360 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019361 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019362 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019363
19364 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019365 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19366 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19367 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019368
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019369 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
19370 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019371
19372 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19373 and processed the connection.
19374
19375 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19376 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19377 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
19378
19379 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19380 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19381 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19382 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
19383 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
19384 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
19385
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019386 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
19387 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
19388 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019389 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019390 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
19391 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019392 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
19393 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019394
19395 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19396 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019397 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019398
19399 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19400 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019401 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
19402 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019403
19404 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
19405 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
19406 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
19407 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
19408 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019409 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
19410 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019411
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019412 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
19413 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
19414 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
19415 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
19416 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
19417 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
19418 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019419 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019420
19421 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
19422 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
19423 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
19424
19425 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19426 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019427 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019428 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19429 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19430 overflowing.
19431
19432 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19433 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19434 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19435 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19436 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19437 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19438 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19439 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19440
19441 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19442 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19443 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19444 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19445 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19446 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19447 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19448 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19449
19450 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19451 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19452 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19453 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19454 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19455 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19456 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19457
19458 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019459 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019460 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19461 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19462 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019463 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019464 system.
19465
19466 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19467 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19468 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19469 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19470 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19471 caused by a denial of service attack.
19472
19473 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19474 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19475 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19476 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19477 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19478 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19479 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19480 denial of service attack.
19481
19482 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19483 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19484 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19485 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19486 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19487 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19488 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19489 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19490 processed than on other servers.
19491
19492 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19493 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19494 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19495 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19496 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19497 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19498 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19499 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19500 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19501 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19502 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19503 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19504 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19505
19506 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19507 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19508 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19509 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19510 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19511 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019512 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019513 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19514
19515 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19516 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19517 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19518 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19519 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19520 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019521 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019522 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19523 occurs.
19524
19525 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19526 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19527 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19528 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19529 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19530 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19531 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19532 cookies" below for more details.
19533
19534 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19535 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19536 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19537 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19538 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19539 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19540 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19541 and cookies" below for more details.
19542
19543 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19544 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19545 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19546 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19547 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19548 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19549 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19550 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19551
19552
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200195538.2.4. Custom log format
19554------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019555
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019556The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019557mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019558
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019559HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019560Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19561separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19562prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19563
19564Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19565variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019566("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019567
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019568If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019569as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019570less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19571the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19572
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019573Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19574"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19575delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19576preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019577
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019578Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19579'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19580https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19581such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19582
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019583Flags are :
19584 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019585 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019586 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19587 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019588
19589 Example:
19590
19591 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19592 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19593
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019594 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19595
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019596At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19597
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019598 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19599 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019600
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019601the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019602
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019603 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19604 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19605 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019606
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019607and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19608
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019609 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19610 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019611
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019612Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19613
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019614 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019615 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019616 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19617 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19618 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019619 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19620 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19621 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019622 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019623 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000019624 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019625 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019626 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19627 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019628 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019629 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019630 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019631 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019632 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019633 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019634 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019635 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19636 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19637 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19638 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19639 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019640 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019641 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019642 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019643 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019644 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019645 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19646 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019647 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19648 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19649 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019650 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019651 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19652 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019653 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019654 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19655 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19656 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019657 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019658 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019659 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19660 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19661 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19662 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019663 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019664 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019665 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019666 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019667 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019668 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019669 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19670 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19671 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019672 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019673 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19674 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019675 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019676 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19677 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019678 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019679 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019680 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019681 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019682
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019683 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019684
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019685
196868.2.5. Error log format
19687-----------------------
19688
19689When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19690protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19691By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19692"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019693will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019694logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19695
19696The format looks like this :
19697
19698 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19699 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19700 Connection error during SSL handshake
19701
19702 Field Format Extract from the example above
19703 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19704 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19705 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19706 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19707 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19708
19709These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19710failures.
19711
19712
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197138.3. Advanced logging options
19714-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019715
19716Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19717just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19718options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19719for more information about their usage.
19720
19721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197228.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19723------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019724
19725It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19726haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19727commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19728monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19729ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19730
19731 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19732 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19733 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19734 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19735
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020019736 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
19737 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019738
19739 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19740 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19741 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19742
19743
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197448.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19745----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019746
19747The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19748what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19749or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019750"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019751just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19752log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19753after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19754is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19755with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19756with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19757
19758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197598.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19760------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019761
19762Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19763for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19764"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19765retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19766raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19767a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19768file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19769you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19770"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19771
19772
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197738.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19774--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019775
19776Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19777multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19778them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19779"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19780logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19781error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19782and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19783too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19784useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19785alternative.
19786
19787
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197888.4. Timing events
19789------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019790
19791Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19792reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19793the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19794frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019795mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19796addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19797
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019798Timings events in HTTP mode:
19799
19800 first request 2nd request
19801 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19802 t tr t tr ...
19803 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19804 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19805 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19806 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019807 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019808 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19809
19810Timings events in TCP mode:
19811
19812 TCP session
19813 |<----------------->|
19814 t t
19815 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19816 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19817 |<------ Tt ------->|
19818
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019819 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019820 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019821 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19822 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19823 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019824 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019825 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19826 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19827 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19828 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019829
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019830 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19831 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19832 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019833 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19834 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19835 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19836 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19837 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19838 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019839
19840 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19841 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19842 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19843 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19844 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19845 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19846 request typed by hand during a test.
19847
19848 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19849 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019850 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019851 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19852 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19853 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19854 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019855
19856 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19857 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19858 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19859 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19860 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19861
19862 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19863 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19864 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19865 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19866 connection never established.
19867
19868 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19869 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19870 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19871 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19872 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19873 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19874 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19875 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19876 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19877 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19878 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19879
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019880 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19881 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19882 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19883 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19884 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19885 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19886
19887 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19888
19889 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19890 "Ta" can never be negative.
19891
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019892 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19893 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019894 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19895 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019896 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019897
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019898 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019899
19900 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019901 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19902 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019903
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019904 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19905 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19906 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19907 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19908 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19909 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19910 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19911 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19912
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019913These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19914protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19915that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019916due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19917"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19918that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019919
19920Most common cases :
19921
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019922 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19923 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19924 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19925 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19926 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19927 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19928 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19929 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19930 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19931 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19932 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019933 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019934
19935 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19936 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19937 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19938 of ms on remote networks.
19939
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019940 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19941 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19942 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019943
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019944 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19945 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19946 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19947 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19948 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19949 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19950 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19951 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19952 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019953
19954Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19955
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019956 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019957 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019958 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019959
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019960 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019961 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19962 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19963
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019964 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019965 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19966 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19967 flags.
19968
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019969 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19970 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019971 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19972 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19973 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19974 the client connection was maintained open.
19975
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019976 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019977 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019978 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019979 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19980
19981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199828.5. Session state at disconnection
19983-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019984
19985TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19986"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
199872-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19988each of which has a special meaning :
19989
19990 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19991 session to terminate :
19992
19993 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19994
19995 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19996 server explicitly refused it.
19997
19998 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19999 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20000 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20001 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020002 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020003
20004 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20005 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020006
20007 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20008 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20009 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20010 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20011 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20012
20013 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20014 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20015 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20016 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20017 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20018
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020019 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20020 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20021
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020022 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20023 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20024 backup connections when going up.
20025
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020026 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20027
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020028 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20029 send or receive data.
20030
20031 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20032 send or receive data.
20033
20034 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20035 with nothing left in the buffers.
20036
20037 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20038
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020039 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020040 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20041
20042 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20043 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20044 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20045 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20046 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20047
20048 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20049 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20050
20051 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20052 server (HTTP only).
20053
20054 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20055
20056 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20057 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20058 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20059
20060 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20061 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20062 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20063
20064 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20065
20066 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20067 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20068
20069 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20070 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20071 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20072
20073 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20074 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020075 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20076 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020077
20078 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20079 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20080 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20081 another server.
20082
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020083 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020084 server.
20085
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020086 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20087 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20088 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20089 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20090
20091 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20092 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20093 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20094 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20095
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020096 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20097 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20098 "use-server" rule).
20099
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020100 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20101
20102 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20103 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20104
20105 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20106
20107 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20108 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20109 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20110
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020111 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20112 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020113 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020114 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20115 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20116
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020117 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20118
20119 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20120 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20121
20122 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20123
20124 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20125
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020126The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20127was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020128helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20129starvation, attacks, etc...
20130
20131The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20132alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20133easier finding and understanding.
20134
20135 Flags Reason
20136
20137 -- Normal termination.
20138
20139 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20140 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20141 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20142 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20143
20144 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20145 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20146 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20147 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20148 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20149 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020150
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020151 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20152 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020153 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020154
20155 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20156 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20157 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20158
20159 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20160 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20161 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20162 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20163 the server takes too long to respond.
20164
20165 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20166 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20167 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20168 long a time to respond.
20169
20170 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20171 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20172 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20173 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020174 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20175 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020176
20177 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20178 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20179 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20180 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20181 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020182 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020183 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20184 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20185 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20186 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20187 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20188 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20189 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20190 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020191 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020192 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20193 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20194 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020195
20196 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20197 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020198 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20199 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20200 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20201 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020202
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020203 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20204 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20205
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020206 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020207 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20208 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020209 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020210 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20211 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20212
20213 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20214 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20215 503 or 504 here.
20216
20217 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20218 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20219 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20220 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20221 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20222
20223 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20224 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020225 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020226 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20227 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20228
20229 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20230 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20231 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20232 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20233 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20234 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20235 between haproxy and the server.
20236
20237 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20238 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20239 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20240 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20241 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20242 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20243 solution is to fix the application.
20244
20245 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20246 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20247 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20248 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20249 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20250 external attacks.
20251
20252 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
20253 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020254 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020255 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20256 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20257
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020258 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20259 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20260 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020261 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020262 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020263
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020264 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20265 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20266 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20267 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020268 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20269 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20270 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20271 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20272 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020273
20274 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20275 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20276 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20277 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20278
20279 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20280 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20281 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20282 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20283
20284 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20285 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20286 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20287 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20288
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020289The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20290persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20291important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20292re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20293
20294 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20295
20296 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20297 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20298 set on a GET request.
20299
20300 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20301 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020302 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020303 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20304
20305 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20306 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20307 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20308
20309 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20310 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20311 already got a cookie.
20312
20313 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20314 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20315 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20316 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20317 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20318
20319 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20320 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20321 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20322
20323 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20324 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20325 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20326
20327 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20328 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20329
20330 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20331 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20332 then advertised in the response.
20333
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020334
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203358.6. Non-printable characters
20336-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020337
20338In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
20339consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
20340converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
20341prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
20342being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
20343escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
20344is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
20345'}' when logging headers.
20346
20347Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
20348issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
20349containing spaces is "User-Agent".
20350
20351Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
20352the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
20353performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
20354
20355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203568.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
20357---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020358
20359Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
20360achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020361section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020362cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
20363the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
20364the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020365locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020366not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
20367user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
20368a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
20369wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
20370
20371 Examples :
20372 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
20373 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
20374
20375 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
20376 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
20377
20378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203798.8. Capturing HTTP headers
20380---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020381
20382Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
20383proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
20384the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
20385server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
20386
20387Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
20388response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020389section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020390
20391It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020392time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
20393appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020394are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
20395and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
20396follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
20397request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
20398in the logs.
20399
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020400As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
20401frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
20402an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
20403
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020404 Example :
20405 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
20406 listen proxy-out
20407 mode http
20408 option httplog
20409 option logasap
20410 log global
20411 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
20412
20413 # log the name of the virtual server
20414 capture request header Host len 20
20415
20416 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
20417 capture request header Content-Length len 10
20418
20419 # log the beginning of the referrer
20420 capture request header Referer len 20
20421
20422 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20423 capture response header Server len 20
20424
20425 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20426 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20427
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020428 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020429 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20430
20431 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20432 capture response header Via len 20
20433
20434 # log the URL location during a redirection
20435 capture response header Location len 20
20436
20437 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20438 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20439 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20440 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20441 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20442
20443 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20444 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20445 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20446 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020447 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020448
20449 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20450 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20451 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20452 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20453 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020454 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020455
20456
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204578.9. Examples of logs
20458---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020459
20460These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20461them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20462reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20463
20464 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20465 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20466 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20467
20468 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20469 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20470
20471 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20472 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20473 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20474
20475 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20476 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20477
20478 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20479 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20480 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20481
20482 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020483 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020484 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20485 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20486
20487 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20488 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20489 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20490
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020491 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20492 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20493 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20494 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20495 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20496 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020497
20498 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020499 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020500
20501 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20502 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20503 Nothing was sent to any server.
20504
20505 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20506 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20507
20508 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20509 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020510 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020511 send a 408 return code to the client.
20512
20513 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20514 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20515
20516 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20517 5 seconds ("c----").
20518
20519 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20520 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020521 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020522
20523 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020524 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020525 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20526 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20527 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20528 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20529 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020530
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020531
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200205329. Supported filters
20533--------------------
20534
20535Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20536accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20537unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20538
20539See also : "filter"
20540
205419.1. Trace
20542----------
20543
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010020544filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020545
20546 Arguments:
20547 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20548 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20549
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010020550 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020551
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020552 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020553 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20554 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20555 amount of the parsed data.
20556
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020557 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020558
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020559This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20560callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20561information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20562filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20563
20564Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20565tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20566a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20567
20568
205699.2. HTTP compression
20570---------------------
20571
20572filter compression
20573
20574The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20575keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020576when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20577fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20578done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20579explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20580filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20581listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20582order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020583
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020584See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20585 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020586
20587
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200205889.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20589--------------------------------------------
20590
20591filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20592
20593 Arguments :
20594
20595 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20596 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20597 parsed.
20598
20599 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20600 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20601 part must be placed in its own scope.
20602
20603The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20604external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020605streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020606exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20607also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20608
20609SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20610the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20611
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020612For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020613"doc/SPOE.txt".
20614
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100206159.4. Cache
20616----------
20617
20618filter cache <name>
20619
20620 Arguments :
20621
20622 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20623
20624The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20625"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020626cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020627other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20628case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20629is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20630filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020631listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20632order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020633
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020634See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20635 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20636
20637
206389.5. Fcgi-app
20639-------------
20640
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020641filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020642
20643 Arguments :
20644
20645 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20646
20647The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20648request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20649reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20650used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20651implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20652used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20653fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20654used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20655order.
20656
20657See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20658 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20659
20660
2066110. FastCGI applications
20662-------------------------
20663
20664HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20665feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20666the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20667FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20668servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20669FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20670backend.
20671
20672HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20673application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20674connection.
20675
2067610.1. Setup
20677-----------
20678
2067910.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20680--------------------------
20681
20682fcgi-app <name>
20683 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20684 document root must be defined.
20685
20686acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20687 Declare or complete an access list.
20688
20689 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20690 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20691 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20692 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20693 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20694
20695docroot <path>
20696 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20697 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20698 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20699
20700index <script-name>
20701 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20702 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20703 is an optional setting.
20704
20705 Example :
20706 index index.php
20707
20708log-stderr global
20709log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20710 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20711 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20712
20713 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20714 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20715
20716pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20717 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20718 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20719 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20720
20721 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20722 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20723 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20724 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20725
20726 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20727 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20728
20729path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020730 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020731 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20732 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20733 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20734 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20735 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20736 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20737 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020738
20739 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020740 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020741 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20742 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20743 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20744 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020745
20746 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020747 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20748 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020749
20750option get-values
20751no option get-values
20752 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20753
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020754 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020755 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20756
20757 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20758 application will accept.
20759
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020760 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20761 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020762
20763 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020764 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020765 option is disabled.
20766
20767 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20768 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20769 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20770 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20771 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20772 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20773
20774option keep-conn
20775no option keep-conn
20776 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20777 sending a response.
20778
20779 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20780 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20781
20782option max-reqs <reqs>
20783 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20784 accept.
20785
20786 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20787 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20788 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20789 to 1.
20790
20791option mpxs-conns
20792no option mpxs-conns
20793 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20794
20795 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20796 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20797
20798set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20799 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20800 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20801 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20802 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20803
20804 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20805 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20806 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20807
20808 Example :
20809 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20810 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20811
20812 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20813
20814
2081510.1.2. Proxy section
20816---------------------
20817
20818use-fcgi-app <name>
20819 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20820
20821 Arguments :
20822 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20823
20824 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20825 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20826 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20827 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20828 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20829
20830 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20831 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20832 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20833 application are evaluated.
20834
20835
2083610.1.3. Example
20837---------------
20838
20839 frontend front-http
20840 mode http
20841 bind *:80
20842 bind *:
20843
20844 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20845 default_backend back-static
20846
20847 backend back-static
20848 mode http
20849 server www A.B.C.D:80
20850
20851 backend back-dynamic
20852 mode http
20853 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20854 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20855
20856 fcgi-app php-fpm
20857 log-stderr global
20858 option keep-conn
20859
20860 docroot /var/www/my-app
20861 index index.php
20862 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20863
20864
2086510.2. Default parameters
20866------------------------
20867
20868A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20869the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020870script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020871applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20872
20873 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20874 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20875 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20876 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20877 | | |
20878 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20879 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20880 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20881 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20882 | | application. |
20883 | | |
20884 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20885 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20886 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20887 | | |
20888 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20889 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20890 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20891 | | the application's configuration. |
20892 | | |
20893 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20894 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20895 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20896 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20897 | | |
20898 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20899 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20900 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20901 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20902 | | be defined. |
20903 | | |
20904 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20905 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20906 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20907 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20908 | | is not set too. |
20909 | | |
20910 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20911 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20912 | | set. |
20913 | | |
20914 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20915 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20916 | | the request. |
20917 | | |
20918 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20919 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20920 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20921 | | |
20922 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20923 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20924 | | script to process the request. |
20925 | | |
20926 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20927 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20928 | | |
20929 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20930 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20931 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20932 | | |
20933 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20934 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20935 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20936 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20937 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20938 | | |
20939 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20940 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20941 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20942 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20943 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20944 | | side. |
20945 | | |
20946 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20947 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20948 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20949 | | connected to. |
20950 | | |
20951 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20952 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20953 | | |
20954 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20955 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20956 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20957 | | |
20958 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20959
20960
2096110.3. Limitations
20962------------------
20963
20964The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20965way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20966during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20967establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20968application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20969or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20970message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20971these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20972and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20973
20974Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20975request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20976requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20977
20978About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20979into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20980fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20981"http-request" ones.
20982
20983Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20984FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20985processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20986must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20987here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020988
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020989/*
20990 * Local variables:
20991 * fill-column: 79
20992 * End:
20993 */